PR 4712
[binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
4 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /*
23 SECTION
24 ELF backends
25
26 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
27 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
28 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
29
30 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
31 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
32 haven't bothered yet. */
33
34 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
35 #define _SYSCALL32
36 #include "sysdep.h"
37 #include "bfd.h"
38 #include "bfdlink.h"
39 #include "libbfd.h"
40 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
41 #include "elf-bfd.h"
42 #include "libiberty.h"
43
44 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
45 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
46 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
47 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct bfd_strtab_hash **, int) ;
48 static bfd_boolean elfcore_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
49
50 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
51 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
52 need to move into elfcode.h. */
53
54 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
55
56 void
57 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
58 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
59 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
60 {
61 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
62 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
63 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
64 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
65 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
66 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
67 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
68 }
69
70 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
71
72 void
73 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
74 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
75 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
76 {
77 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
78 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
79 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
80 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
81 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
82 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
83 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
84 }
85
86 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
87
88 void
89 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
90 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
91 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
92 {
93 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
94 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
95 }
96
97 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
98
99 void
100 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
101 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
102 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
103 {
104 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
105 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
106 }
107
108 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
109
110 void
111 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
112 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
113 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
114 {
115 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
116 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
117 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
118 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
119 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
120 }
121
122 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
123
124 void
125 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
126 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
127 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
128 {
129 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
130 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
131 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
132 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
133 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
134 }
135
136 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
137
138 void
139 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
140 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
141 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
142 {
143 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
144 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
145 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
146 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
147 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
148 }
149
150 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
151
152 void
153 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
154 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
155 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
156 {
157 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
158 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
159 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
160 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
161 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
162 }
163
164 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
165
166 void
167 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
168 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
169 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
170 {
171 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
172 }
173
174 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
175
176 void
177 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
178 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
179 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
180 {
181 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
182 }
183
184 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
185 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
186
187 unsigned long
188 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
189 {
190 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
191 unsigned long h = 0;
192 unsigned long g;
193 int ch;
194
195 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
196 {
197 h = (h << 4) + ch;
198 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
199 {
200 h ^= g >> 24;
201 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
202 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
203 h ^= g;
204 }
205 }
206 return h & 0xffffffff;
207 }
208
209 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
210 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
211
212 unsigned long
213 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
214 {
215 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
216 unsigned long h = 5381;
217 unsigned char ch;
218
219 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
220 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
221 return h & 0xffffffff;
222 }
223
224 bfd_boolean
225 bfd_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
226 {
227 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
228 {
229 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
230 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
231 return FALSE;
232 }
233
234 elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = (bfd_size_type) -1;
235
236 return TRUE;
237 }
238
239 bfd_boolean
240 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
241 {
242 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
243 return bfd_elf_mkobject (abfd);
244 }
245
246 char *
247 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
248 {
249 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
250 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
251 file_ptr offset;
252 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
253
254 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
255 if (i_shdrp == 0
256 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
257 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
258 return NULL;
259
260 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
261 if (shstrtab == NULL)
262 {
263 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
264 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
265 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
266
267 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
268 in case the string table is not terminated. */
269 if (shstrtabsize + 1 == 0
270 || (shstrtab = bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL
271 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
272 shstrtab = NULL;
273 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
274 {
275 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
276 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
277 shstrtab = NULL;
278 }
279 else
280 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
281 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
282 }
283 return (char *) shstrtab;
284 }
285
286 char *
287 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
288 unsigned int shindex,
289 unsigned int strindex)
290 {
291 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
292
293 if (strindex == 0)
294 return "";
295
296 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
297 return NULL;
298
299 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
300
301 if (hdr->contents == NULL
302 && bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
303 return NULL;
304
305 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
306 {
307 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
308 (*_bfd_error_handler)
309 (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
310 abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
311 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
312 ? ".shstrtab"
313 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
314 return "";
315 }
316
317 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
318 }
319
320 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
321 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
322 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
323 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
324 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively. */
325
326 Elf_Internal_Sym *
327 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
328 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
329 size_t symcount,
330 size_t symoffset,
331 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
332 void *extsym_buf,
333 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
334 {
335 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
336 void *alloc_ext;
337 const bfd_byte *esym;
338 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
339 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
340 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
341 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
342 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
343 size_t extsym_size;
344 bfd_size_type amt;
345 file_ptr pos;
346
347 if (symcount == 0)
348 return intsym_buf;
349
350 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
351 shndx_hdr = NULL;
352 if (symtab_hdr == &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_hdr)
353 shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
354
355 /* Read the symbols. */
356 alloc_ext = NULL;
357 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
358 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
359 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
360 amt = symcount * extsym_size;
361 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
362 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
363 {
364 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
365 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
366 }
367 if (extsym_buf == NULL
368 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
369 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
370 {
371 intsym_buf = NULL;
372 goto out;
373 }
374
375 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
376 extshndx_buf = NULL;
377 else
378 {
379 amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
380 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
381 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
382 {
383 alloc_extshndx = bfd_malloc2 (symcount,
384 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
385 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
386 }
387 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
388 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
389 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
390 {
391 intsym_buf = NULL;
392 goto out;
393 }
394 }
395
396 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
397 {
398 intsym_buf = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
399 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
400 goto out;
401 }
402
403 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
404 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
405 for (esym = extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf, shndx = extshndx_buf;
406 isym < isymend;
407 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
408 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
409 {
410 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
411 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
412 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
413 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
414 intsym_buf = NULL;
415 goto out;
416 }
417
418 out:
419 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
420 free (alloc_ext);
421 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
422 free (alloc_extshndx);
423
424 return intsym_buf;
425 }
426
427 /* Look up a symbol name. */
428 const char *
429 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
430 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
431 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
432 asection *sym_sec)
433 {
434 const char *name;
435 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
436 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
437
438 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
439 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
440 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd)
441 && !(isym->st_shndx >= SHN_LORESERVE && isym->st_shndx <= SHN_HIRESERVE))
442 {
443 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
444 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
445 }
446
447 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
448 if (name == NULL)
449 name = "(null)";
450 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
451 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
452
453 return name;
454 }
455
456 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
457 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
458 pointers. */
459
460 typedef union elf_internal_group {
461 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
462 unsigned int flags;
463 } Elf_Internal_Group;
464
465 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
466 signature just a string? */
467
468 static const char *
469 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
470 {
471 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
472 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
473 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
474 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
475
476 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
477 that it is a symbol table section. */
478 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
479 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
480 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
481 return NULL;
482
483 /* Go read the symbol. */
484 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
485 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
486 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
487 return NULL;
488
489 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
490 }
491
492 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
493
494 static bfd_boolean
495 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
496 {
497 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
498
499 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
500 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
501 if (num_group == 0)
502 {
503 unsigned int i, shnum;
504
505 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
506 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
507 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
508 num_group = 0;
509
510 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr) \
511 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
512 && (shdr)->sh_size >= (2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) \
513 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
514 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
515
516 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
517 {
518 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
519
520 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
521 num_group += 1;
522 }
523
524 if (num_group == 0)
525 {
526 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
527 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
528 }
529 else
530 {
531 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
532 so we can find them quickly. */
533 bfd_size_type amt;
534
535 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
536 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr
537 = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
538 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
539 return FALSE;
540
541 num_group = 0;
542 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
543 {
544 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
545
546 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
547 {
548 unsigned char *src;
549 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
550
551 /* Add to list of sections. */
552 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
553 num_group += 1;
554
555 /* Read the raw contents. */
556 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
557 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
558 shdr->contents = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size,
559 sizeof (*dest) / 4);
560 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
561 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
562 {
563 _bfd_error_handler
564 (_("%B: Corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
565 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
566 return FALSE;
567 }
568
569 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
570
571 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
572 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
573 != shdr->sh_size))
574 return FALSE;
575
576 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
577 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
578 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
579 pointers. */
580 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
581 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
582 while (1)
583 {
584 unsigned int idx;
585
586 src -= 4;
587 --dest;
588 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
589 if (src == shdr->contents)
590 {
591 dest->flags = idx;
592 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
593 shdr->bfd_section->flags
594 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
595 break;
596 }
597 if (idx >= shnum)
598 {
599 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
600 (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
601 idx = 0;
602 }
603 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
604 }
605 }
606 }
607 }
608 }
609
610 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
611 {
612 unsigned int i;
613
614 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
615 {
616 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
617 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
618 unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
619
620 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
621 section is a member. */
622 while (--n_elt != 0)
623 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
624 {
625 asection *s = NULL;
626
627 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
628 other members to see if any others are linked via
629 next_in_group. */
630 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
631 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
632 while (--n_elt != 0)
633 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
634 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
635 break;
636 if (n_elt != 0)
637 {
638 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
639 insert current section in circular list. */
640 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
641 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
642 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
643 }
644 else
645 {
646 const char *gname;
647
648 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
649 if (gname == NULL)
650 return FALSE;
651 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
652
653 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
654 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
655 }
656
657 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
658 new member. */
659 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
660 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
661
662 i = num_group - 1;
663 break;
664 }
665 }
666 }
667
668 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
669 {
670 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
671 abfd, newsect);
672 }
673 return TRUE;
674 }
675
676 bfd_boolean
677 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
678 {
679 unsigned int i;
680 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
681 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
682 asection *s;
683
684 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
685 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
686 {
687 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
688 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
689 {
690 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
691 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
692 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
693 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
694 if (elfsec == 0)
695 {
696 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
697 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
698 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
699 bed->link_order_error_handler
700 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
701 abfd, s);
702 }
703 else
704 {
705 asection *link;
706
707 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
708
709 /* PR 1991, 2008:
710 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
711 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
712 link = this_hdr->bfd_section;
713 if (link == NULL)
714 {
715 (*_bfd_error_handler)
716 (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
717 s->owner, s, elfsec);
718 result = FALSE;
719 }
720
721 elf_linked_to_section (s) = link;
722 }
723 }
724 }
725
726 /* Process section groups. */
727 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
728 return result;
729
730 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
731 {
732 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
733 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
734 unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
735
736 while (--n_elt != 0)
737 if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
738 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
739 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
740 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
741 /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
742 output object files. We adjust the group section size here
743 so that relocatable link will work correctly when
744 relocation sections are in section group in input object
745 files. */
746 shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
747 else
748 {
749 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
750 (*_bfd_error_handler)
751 (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
752 abfd,
753 (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
754 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
755 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
756 ->e_shstrndx),
757 idx->shdr->sh_name),
758 shdr->bfd_section->name);
759 result = FALSE;
760 }
761 }
762 return result;
763 }
764
765 bfd_boolean
766 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
767 {
768 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
769 }
770
771 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
772 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
773
774 bfd_boolean
775 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
776 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
777 const char *name,
778 int shindex)
779 {
780 asection *newsect;
781 flagword flags;
782 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
783
784 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
785 {
786 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (name,
787 bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section)) == 0);
788 return TRUE;
789 }
790
791 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
792 if (newsect == NULL)
793 return FALSE;
794
795 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
796 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
797 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
798
799 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
800 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
801 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
802
803 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
804
805 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
806 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
807 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
808 bfd_log2 ((bfd_vma) hdr->sh_addralign)))
809 return FALSE;
810
811 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
812 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
813 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
814 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
815 flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
816 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
817 {
818 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
819 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
820 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
821 }
822 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
823 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
824 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
825 flags |= SEC_CODE;
826 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
827 flags |= SEC_DATA;
828 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
829 {
830 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
831 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
832 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
833 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
834 }
835 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
836 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
837 return FALSE;
838 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
839 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
840
841 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
842 {
843 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
844 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
845 static const struct
846 {
847 const char *name;
848 int len;
849 } debug_sections [] =
850 {
851 { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("debug") }, /* 'd' */
852 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'e' */
853 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'f' */
854 { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("gnu.linkonce.wi.") }, /* 'g' */
855 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'h' */
856 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'i' */
857 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'j' */
858 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'k' */
859 { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("line") }, /* 'l' */
860 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'm' */
861 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'n' */
862 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'o' */
863 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'p' */
864 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'q' */
865 { NULL, 0 }, /* 'r' */
866 { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("stab") } /* 's' */
867 };
868
869 if (name [0] == '.')
870 {
871 int i = name [1] - 'd';
872 if (i >= 0
873 && i < (int) ARRAY_SIZE (debug_sections)
874 && debug_sections [i].name != NULL
875 && strncmp (&name [1], debug_sections [i].name,
876 debug_sections [i].len) == 0)
877 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
878 }
879 }
880
881 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
882 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
883 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
884 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
885 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
886 all but one of the sections. */
887 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
888 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
889 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
890
891 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
892 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
893 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
894 return FALSE;
895
896 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
897 return FALSE;
898
899 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
900 {
901 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
902 unsigned int i;
903
904 /* Look through the phdrs to see if we need to adjust the lma.
905 If all the p_paddr fields are zero, we ignore them, since
906 some ELF linkers produce such output. */
907 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
908 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
909 {
910 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
911 break;
912 }
913 if (i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum)
914 {
915 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
916 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
917 {
918 /* This section is part of this segment if its file
919 offset plus size lies within the segment's memory
920 span and, if the section is loaded, the extent of the
921 loaded data lies within the extent of the segment.
922
923 Note - we used to check the p_paddr field as well, and
924 refuse to set the LMA if it was 0. This is wrong
925 though, as a perfectly valid initialised segment can
926 have a p_paddr of zero. Some architectures, eg ARM,
927 place special significance on the address 0 and
928 executables need to be able to have a segment which
929 covers this address. */
930 if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
931 && (bfd_vma) hdr->sh_offset >= phdr->p_offset
932 && (hdr->sh_offset + hdr->sh_size
933 <= phdr->p_offset + phdr->p_memsz)
934 && ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0
935 || (hdr->sh_offset + hdr->sh_size
936 <= phdr->p_offset + phdr->p_filesz)))
937 {
938 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
939 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
940 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
941 else
942 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
943 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
944 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
945 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
946 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
947 segment will contain sections with contiguous
948 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
949 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
950 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
951
952 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
953 offsets whether a section with zero size should
954 be placed at the end of one segment or the
955 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
956 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
957 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
958 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
959 break;
960 }
961 }
962 }
963 }
964
965 return TRUE;
966 }
967
968 /*
969 INTERNAL_FUNCTION
970 bfd_elf_find_section
971
972 SYNOPSIS
973 struct elf_internal_shdr *bfd_elf_find_section (bfd *abfd, char *name);
974
975 DESCRIPTION
976 Helper functions for GDB to locate the string tables.
977 Since BFD hides string tables from callers, GDB needs to use an
978 internal hook to find them. Sun's .stabstr, in particular,
979 isn't even pointed to by the .stab section, so ordinary
980 mechanisms wouldn't work to find it, even if we had some.
981 */
982
983 struct elf_internal_shdr *
984 bfd_elf_find_section (bfd *abfd, char *name)
985 {
986 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
987 char *shstrtab;
988 unsigned int max;
989 unsigned int i;
990
991 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
992 if (i_shdrp != NULL)
993 {
994 shstrtab = bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd,
995 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx);
996 if (shstrtab != NULL)
997 {
998 max = elf_numsections (abfd);
999 for (i = 1; i < max; i++)
1000 if (!strcmp (&shstrtab[i_shdrp[i]->sh_name], name))
1001 return i_shdrp[i];
1002 }
1003 }
1004 return 0;
1005 }
1006
1007 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
1008 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1009 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1010 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1011 };
1012
1013 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1014 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1015 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1016 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1017 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1018 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1019 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1020 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1021 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1022
1023 bfd_reloc_status_type
1024 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1025 arelent *reloc_entry,
1026 asymbol *symbol,
1027 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1028 asection *input_section,
1029 bfd *output_bfd,
1030 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1031 {
1032 if (output_bfd != NULL
1033 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1034 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1035 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1036 {
1037 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1038 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1039 }
1040
1041 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1042 }
1043 \f
1044 /* Make sure sec_info_type is cleared if sec_info is cleared too. */
1045
1046 static void
1047 merge_sections_remove_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1048 asection *sec)
1049 {
1050 BFD_ASSERT (sec->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE);
1051 sec->sec_info_type = ELF_INFO_TYPE_NONE;
1052 }
1053
1054 /* Finish SHF_MERGE section merging. */
1055
1056 bfd_boolean
1057 _bfd_elf_merge_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
1058 {
1059 bfd *ibfd;
1060 asection *sec;
1061
1062 if (!is_elf_hash_table (info->hash))
1063 return FALSE;
1064
1065 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link_next)
1066 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0)
1067 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
1068 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0
1069 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
1070 {
1071 struct bfd_elf_section_data *secdata;
1072
1073 secdata = elf_section_data (sec);
1074 if (! _bfd_add_merge_section (abfd,
1075 &elf_hash_table (info)->merge_info,
1076 sec, &secdata->sec_info))
1077 return FALSE;
1078 else if (secdata->sec_info)
1079 sec->sec_info_type = ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE;
1080 }
1081
1082 if (elf_hash_table (info)->merge_info != NULL)
1083 _bfd_merge_sections (abfd, info, elf_hash_table (info)->merge_info,
1084 merge_sections_remove_hook);
1085 return TRUE;
1086 }
1087
1088 void
1089 _bfd_elf_link_just_syms (asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *info)
1090 {
1091 sec->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1092 sec->output_offset = sec->vma;
1093 if (!is_elf_hash_table (info->hash))
1094 return;
1095
1096 sec->sec_info_type = ELF_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS;
1097 }
1098 \f
1099 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1100 another. */
1101
1102 bfd_boolean
1103 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1104 {
1105 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1106 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1107 return TRUE;
1108
1109 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (obfd)
1110 || (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
1111 == elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags));
1112
1113 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1114 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1115 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1116
1117 /* Copy object attributes. */
1118 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1119
1120 return TRUE;
1121 }
1122
1123 static const char *
1124 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1125 {
1126 const char *pt;
1127 switch (p_type)
1128 {
1129 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1130 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1131 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1132 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1133 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1134 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1135 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1136 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1137 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1138 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1139 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1140 default: pt = NULL; break;
1141 }
1142 return pt;
1143 }
1144
1145 /* Print out the program headers. */
1146
1147 bfd_boolean
1148 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1149 {
1150 FILE *f = farg;
1151 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1152 asection *s;
1153 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1154
1155 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1156 if (p != NULL)
1157 {
1158 unsigned int i, c;
1159
1160 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1161 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1162 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1163 {
1164 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1165 char buf[20];
1166
1167 if (pt == NULL)
1168 {
1169 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1170 pt = buf;
1171 }
1172 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1173 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1174 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1175 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1176 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1177 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1178 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1179 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1180 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1181 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1182 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1183 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1184 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1185 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1186 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1187 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1188 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1189 fprintf (f, "\n");
1190 }
1191 }
1192
1193 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1194 if (s != NULL)
1195 {
1196 int elfsec;
1197 unsigned long shlink;
1198 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1199 size_t extdynsize;
1200 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1201
1202 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1203
1204 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1205 goto error_return;
1206
1207 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1208 if (elfsec == -1)
1209 goto error_return;
1210 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1211
1212 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1213 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1214
1215 extdyn = dynbuf;
1216 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1217 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1218 {
1219 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1220 const char *name;
1221 char ab[20];
1222 bfd_boolean stringp;
1223
1224 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1225
1226 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1227 break;
1228
1229 stringp = FALSE;
1230 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1231 {
1232 default:
1233 sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1234 name = ab;
1235 break;
1236
1237 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1238 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1239 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1240 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1241 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1242 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1243 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1244 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1245 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1246 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1247 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1248 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1249 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1250 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1251 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1252 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1253 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1254 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1255 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1256 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1257 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1258 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1259 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1260 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1261 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1262 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1263 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1264 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1265 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1266 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1267 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1268 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1269 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1270 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1271 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1272 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1273 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1274 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1275 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1276 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1277 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1278 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1279 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1280 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1281 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1282 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1283 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1284 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1285 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1286 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1287 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1288 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1289 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1290 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1291 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1292 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1293 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1294 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1295 }
1296
1297 fprintf (f, " %-11s ", name);
1298 if (! stringp)
1299 fprintf (f, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_un.d_val);
1300 else
1301 {
1302 const char *string;
1303 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1304
1305 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1306 if (string == NULL)
1307 goto error_return;
1308 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1309 }
1310 fprintf (f, "\n");
1311 }
1312
1313 free (dynbuf);
1314 dynbuf = NULL;
1315 }
1316
1317 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1318 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1319 {
1320 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1321 return FALSE;
1322 }
1323
1324 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1325 {
1326 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1327
1328 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1329 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1330 {
1331 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1332 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1333 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1334 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1335 {
1336 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1337
1338 fprintf (f, "\t");
1339 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1340 a != NULL;
1341 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1342 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1343 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1344 fprintf (f, "\n");
1345 }
1346 }
1347 }
1348
1349 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1350 {
1351 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1352
1353 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1354 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1355 {
1356 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1357
1358 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1359 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1360 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1361 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1362 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1363 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1364 }
1365 }
1366
1367 return TRUE;
1368
1369 error_return:
1370 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1371 free (dynbuf);
1372 return FALSE;
1373 }
1374
1375 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1376
1377 void
1378 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1379 void *filep,
1380 asymbol *symbol,
1381 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1382 {
1383 FILE *file = filep;
1384 switch (how)
1385 {
1386 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1387 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1388 break;
1389 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1390 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1391 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1392 fprintf (file, " %lx", (long) symbol->flags);
1393 break;
1394 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1395 {
1396 const char *section_name;
1397 const char *name = NULL;
1398 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1399 unsigned char st_other;
1400 bfd_vma val;
1401
1402 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1403
1404 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1405 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1406 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1407
1408 if (name == NULL)
1409 {
1410 name = symbol->name;
1411 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1412 }
1413
1414 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1415 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1416 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1417 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1418 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1419 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1420 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1421 else
1422 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1423 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1424
1425 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1426 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_section != 0
1427 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_section != 0
1428 || elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_section != 0))
1429 {
1430 unsigned int vernum;
1431 const char *version_string;
1432
1433 vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_VERSION;
1434
1435 if (vernum == 0)
1436 version_string = "";
1437 else if (vernum == 1)
1438 version_string = "Base";
1439 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1440 version_string =
1441 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1442 else
1443 {
1444 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1445
1446 version_string = "";
1447 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1448 t != NULL;
1449 t = t->vn_nextref)
1450 {
1451 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1452
1453 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1454 {
1455 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1456 {
1457 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1458 break;
1459 }
1460 }
1461 }
1462 }
1463
1464 if ((((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_HIDDEN) == 0)
1465 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1466 else
1467 {
1468 int i;
1469
1470 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1471 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1472 putc (' ', file);
1473 }
1474 }
1475
1476 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1477 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1478
1479 switch (st_other)
1480 {
1481 case 0: break;
1482 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1483 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1484 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1485 default:
1486 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1487 everything hex. */
1488 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1489 }
1490
1491 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1492 }
1493 break;
1494 }
1495 }
1496 \f
1497 /* Create an entry in an ELF linker hash table. */
1498
1499 struct bfd_hash_entry *
1500 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
1501 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
1502 const char *string)
1503 {
1504 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
1505 subclass. */
1506 if (entry == NULL)
1507 {
1508 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct elf_link_hash_entry));
1509 if (entry == NULL)
1510 return entry;
1511 }
1512
1513 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
1514 entry = _bfd_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
1515 if (entry != NULL)
1516 {
1517 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ret = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
1518 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = (struct elf_link_hash_table *) table;
1519
1520 /* Set local fields. */
1521 ret->indx = -1;
1522 ret->dynindx = -1;
1523 ret->got = htab->init_got_refcount;
1524 ret->plt = htab->init_plt_refcount;
1525 memset (&ret->size, 0, (sizeof (struct elf_link_hash_entry)
1526 - offsetof (struct elf_link_hash_entry, size)));
1527 /* Assume that we have been called by a non-ELF symbol reader.
1528 This flag is then reset by the code which reads an ELF input
1529 file. This ensures that a symbol created by a non-ELF symbol
1530 reader will have the flag set correctly. */
1531 ret->non_elf = 1;
1532 }
1533
1534 return entry;
1535 }
1536
1537 /* Copy data from an indirect symbol to its direct symbol, hiding the
1538 old indirect symbol. Also used for copying flags to a weakdef. */
1539
1540 void
1541 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1542 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
1543 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
1544 {
1545 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1546
1547 /* Copy down any references that we may have already seen to the
1548 symbol which just became indirect. */
1549
1550 dir->ref_dynamic |= ind->ref_dynamic;
1551 dir->ref_regular |= ind->ref_regular;
1552 dir->ref_regular_nonweak |= ind->ref_regular_nonweak;
1553 dir->non_got_ref |= ind->non_got_ref;
1554 dir->needs_plt |= ind->needs_plt;
1555 dir->pointer_equality_needed |= ind->pointer_equality_needed;
1556
1557 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1558 return;
1559
1560 /* Copy over the global and procedure linkage table refcount entries.
1561 These may have been already set up by a check_relocs routine. */
1562 htab = elf_hash_table (info);
1563 if (ind->got.refcount > htab->init_got_refcount.refcount)
1564 {
1565 if (dir->got.refcount < 0)
1566 dir->got.refcount = 0;
1567 dir->got.refcount += ind->got.refcount;
1568 ind->got.refcount = htab->init_got_refcount.refcount;
1569 }
1570
1571 if (ind->plt.refcount > htab->init_plt_refcount.refcount)
1572 {
1573 if (dir->plt.refcount < 0)
1574 dir->plt.refcount = 0;
1575 dir->plt.refcount += ind->plt.refcount;
1576 ind->plt.refcount = htab->init_plt_refcount.refcount;
1577 }
1578
1579 if (ind->dynindx != -1)
1580 {
1581 if (dir->dynindx != -1)
1582 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (htab->dynstr, dir->dynstr_index);
1583 dir->dynindx = ind->dynindx;
1584 dir->dynstr_index = ind->dynstr_index;
1585 ind->dynindx = -1;
1586 ind->dynstr_index = 0;
1587 }
1588 }
1589
1590 void
1591 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1592 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1593 bfd_boolean force_local)
1594 {
1595 h->plt = elf_hash_table (info)->init_plt_offset;
1596 h->needs_plt = 0;
1597 if (force_local)
1598 {
1599 h->forced_local = 1;
1600 if (h->dynindx != -1)
1601 {
1602 h->dynindx = -1;
1603 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
1604 h->dynstr_index);
1605 }
1606 }
1607 }
1608
1609 /* Initialize an ELF linker hash table. */
1610
1611 bfd_boolean
1612 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init
1613 (struct elf_link_hash_table *table,
1614 bfd *abfd,
1615 struct bfd_hash_entry *(*newfunc) (struct bfd_hash_entry *,
1616 struct bfd_hash_table *,
1617 const char *),
1618 unsigned int entsize)
1619 {
1620 bfd_boolean ret;
1621 int can_refcount = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->can_refcount;
1622
1623 memset (table, 0, sizeof * table);
1624 table->init_got_refcount.refcount = can_refcount - 1;
1625 table->init_plt_refcount.refcount = can_refcount - 1;
1626 table->init_got_offset.offset = -(bfd_vma) 1;
1627 table->init_plt_offset.offset = -(bfd_vma) 1;
1628 /* The first dynamic symbol is a dummy. */
1629 table->dynsymcount = 1;
1630
1631 ret = _bfd_link_hash_table_init (&table->root, abfd, newfunc, entsize);
1632 table->root.type = bfd_link_elf_hash_table;
1633
1634 return ret;
1635 }
1636
1637 /* Create an ELF linker hash table. */
1638
1639 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
1640 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
1641 {
1642 struct elf_link_hash_table *ret;
1643 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct elf_link_hash_table);
1644
1645 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
1646 if (ret == NULL)
1647 return NULL;
1648
1649 if (! _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (ret, abfd, _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
1650 sizeof (struct elf_link_hash_entry)))
1651 {
1652 free (ret);
1653 return NULL;
1654 }
1655
1656 return &ret->root;
1657 }
1658
1659 /* This is a hook for the ELF emulation code in the generic linker to
1660 tell the backend linker what file name to use for the DT_NEEDED
1661 entry for a dynamic object. */
1662
1663 void
1664 bfd_elf_set_dt_needed_name (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
1665 {
1666 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour
1667 && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
1668 elf_dt_name (abfd) = name;
1669 }
1670
1671 int
1672 bfd_elf_get_dyn_lib_class (bfd *abfd)
1673 {
1674 int lib_class;
1675 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour
1676 && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
1677 lib_class = elf_dyn_lib_class (abfd);
1678 else
1679 lib_class = 0;
1680 return lib_class;
1681 }
1682
1683 void
1684 bfd_elf_set_dyn_lib_class (bfd *abfd, enum dynamic_lib_link_class lib_class)
1685 {
1686 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour
1687 && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
1688 elf_dyn_lib_class (abfd) = lib_class;
1689 }
1690
1691 /* Get the list of DT_NEEDED entries for a link. This is a hook for
1692 the linker ELF emulation code. */
1693
1694 struct bfd_link_needed_list *
1695 bfd_elf_get_needed_list (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1696 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1697 {
1698 if (! is_elf_hash_table (info->hash))
1699 return NULL;
1700 return elf_hash_table (info)->needed;
1701 }
1702
1703 /* Get the list of DT_RPATH/DT_RUNPATH entries for a link. This is a
1704 hook for the linker ELF emulation code. */
1705
1706 struct bfd_link_needed_list *
1707 bfd_elf_get_runpath_list (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1708 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1709 {
1710 if (! is_elf_hash_table (info->hash))
1711 return NULL;
1712 return elf_hash_table (info)->runpath;
1713 }
1714
1715 /* Get the name actually used for a dynamic object for a link. This
1716 is the SONAME entry if there is one. Otherwise, it is the string
1717 passed to bfd_elf_set_dt_needed_name, or it is the filename. */
1718
1719 const char *
1720 bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (bfd *abfd)
1721 {
1722 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour
1723 && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
1724 return elf_dt_name (abfd);
1725 return NULL;
1726 }
1727
1728 /* Get the list of DT_NEEDED entries from a BFD. This is a hook for
1729 the ELF linker emulation code. */
1730
1731 bfd_boolean
1732 bfd_elf_get_bfd_needed_list (bfd *abfd,
1733 struct bfd_link_needed_list **pneeded)
1734 {
1735 asection *s;
1736 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1737 int elfsec;
1738 unsigned long shlink;
1739 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1740 size_t extdynsize;
1741 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1742
1743 *pneeded = NULL;
1744
1745 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1746 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_object)
1747 return TRUE;
1748
1749 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1750 if (s == NULL || s->size == 0)
1751 return TRUE;
1752
1753 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1754 goto error_return;
1755
1756 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1757 if (elfsec == -1)
1758 goto error_return;
1759
1760 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1761
1762 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1763 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1764
1765 extdyn = dynbuf;
1766 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1767 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1768 {
1769 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1770
1771 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1772
1773 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1774 break;
1775
1776 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NEEDED)
1777 {
1778 const char *string;
1779 struct bfd_link_needed_list *l;
1780 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1781 bfd_size_type amt;
1782
1783 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1784 if (string == NULL)
1785 goto error_return;
1786
1787 amt = sizeof *l;
1788 l = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
1789 if (l == NULL)
1790 goto error_return;
1791
1792 l->by = abfd;
1793 l->name = string;
1794 l->next = *pneeded;
1795 *pneeded = l;
1796 }
1797 }
1798
1799 free (dynbuf);
1800
1801 return TRUE;
1802
1803 error_return:
1804 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1805 free (dynbuf);
1806 return FALSE;
1807 }
1808 \f
1809 /* Allocate an ELF string table--force the first byte to be zero. */
1810
1811 struct bfd_strtab_hash *
1812 _bfd_elf_stringtab_init (void)
1813 {
1814 struct bfd_strtab_hash *ret;
1815
1816 ret = _bfd_stringtab_init ();
1817 if (ret != NULL)
1818 {
1819 bfd_size_type loc;
1820
1821 loc = _bfd_stringtab_add (ret, "", TRUE, FALSE);
1822 BFD_ASSERT (loc == 0 || loc == (bfd_size_type) -1);
1823 if (loc == (bfd_size_type) -1)
1824 {
1825 _bfd_stringtab_free (ret);
1826 ret = NULL;
1827 }
1828 }
1829 return ret;
1830 }
1831 \f
1832 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1833
1834 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1835
1836 bfd_boolean
1837 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1838 {
1839 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1840 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1841 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1842 const char *name;
1843
1844 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
1845 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx,
1846 hdr->sh_name);
1847 if (name == NULL)
1848 return FALSE;
1849
1850 switch (hdr->sh_type)
1851 {
1852 case SHT_NULL:
1853 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
1854 return TRUE;
1855
1856 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
1857 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
1858 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
1859 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
1860 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
1861 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
1862 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
1863 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
1864 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
1865 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1866
1867 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
1868 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1869 return FALSE;
1870 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd)
1871 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
1872 return FALSE;
1873 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
1874 {
1875 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
1876
1877 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
1878 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
1879 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
1880 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
1881 {
1882 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
1883 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1884 }
1885 else
1886 {
1887 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1888
1889 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1890 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1891 {
1892 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1893 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
1894 {
1895 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
1896 break;
1897 }
1898 }
1899 }
1900 }
1901 break;
1902
1903 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table */
1904 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1905 return TRUE;
1906
1907 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1908 return FALSE;
1909 BFD_ASSERT (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0);
1910 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1911 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr = *hdr;
1912 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1913 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1914
1915 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
1916 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
1917 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
1918 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
1919 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
1920 linker. */
1921 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
1922 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
1923 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
1924 shindex))
1925 return FALSE;
1926
1927 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
1928 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
1929 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
1930 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]->sh_link != shindex)
1931 {
1932 unsigned int i, num_sec;
1933
1934 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
1935 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
1936 {
1937 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1938 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1939 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1940 break;
1941 }
1942 if (i == num_sec)
1943 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
1944 {
1945 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
1946 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
1947 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
1948 break;
1949 }
1950 if (i != shindex)
1951 return bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
1952 }
1953 return TRUE;
1954
1955 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table */
1956 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
1957 return TRUE;
1958
1959 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
1960 return FALSE;
1961 BFD_ASSERT (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0);
1962 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
1963 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
1964 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
1965 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
1966
1967 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
1968 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
1969 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
1970
1971 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections */
1972 if (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == shindex)
1973 return TRUE;
1974
1975 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == 0);
1976 elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = shindex;
1977 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr = *hdr;
1978 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
1979 return TRUE;
1980
1981 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table */
1982 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1983 return TRUE;
1984 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
1985 {
1986 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
1987 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
1988 return TRUE;
1989 }
1990 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1991 {
1992 symtab_strtab:
1993 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
1994 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
1995 return TRUE;
1996 }
1997 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
1998 {
1999 dynsymtab_strtab:
2000 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2001 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2002 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2003 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2004 can handle it. */
2005 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2006 shindex);
2007 }
2008
2009 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2010 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2011 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2012 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2013 {
2014 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2015
2016 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2017 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2018 {
2019 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2020 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2021 {
2022 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2023 if (i == shindex)
2024 return FALSE;
2025 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2026 return FALSE;
2027 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2028 goto symtab_strtab;
2029 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2030 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2031 }
2032 }
2033 }
2034 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2035
2036 case SHT_REL:
2037 case SHT_RELA:
2038 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2039 {
2040 asection *target_sect;
2041 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2;
2042 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2043
2044 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2045 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2046 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2047 return FALSE;
2048
2049 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2050 if ((hdr->sh_link >= SHN_LORESERVE && hdr->sh_link <= SHN_HIRESERVE)
2051 || hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2052 {
2053 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
2054 (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2055 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
2056 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2057 shindex);
2058 }
2059
2060 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2061 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2062 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2063 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2064 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2065 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2066 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything. */
2067 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2068 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2069 {
2070 unsigned int scan;
2071 int found;
2072
2073 found = 0;
2074 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2075 {
2076 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2077 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2078 {
2079 if (found != 0)
2080 {
2081 found = 0;
2082 break;
2083 }
2084 found = scan;
2085 }
2086 }
2087 if (found != 0)
2088 hdr->sh_link = found;
2089 }
2090
2091 /* Get the symbol table. */
2092 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2093 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2094 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2095 return FALSE;
2096
2097 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2098 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2099 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2100 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2101 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2102 section, an invalid section, or another reloc section. */
2103 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2104 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2105 || (hdr->sh_info >= SHN_LORESERVE && hdr->sh_info <= SHN_HIRESERVE)
2106 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2107 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2108 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2109 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2110 shindex);
2111
2112 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2113 return FALSE;
2114 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2115 if (target_sect == NULL)
2116 return FALSE;
2117
2118 if ((target_sect->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
2119 || target_sect->reloc_count == 0)
2120 hdr2 = &elf_section_data (target_sect)->rel_hdr;
2121 else
2122 {
2123 bfd_size_type amt;
2124 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (target_sect)->rel_hdr2 == NULL);
2125 amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
2126 hdr2 = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2127 elf_section_data (target_sect)->rel_hdr2 = hdr2;
2128 }
2129 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2130 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2131 target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
2132 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2133 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2134 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2135 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2136 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2137 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2138 target_sect->use_rela_p = hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA;
2139 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2140 return TRUE;
2141 }
2142
2143 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2144 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2145 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2146 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2147
2148 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2149 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2150 return FALSE;
2151 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2152 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2153 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2154
2155 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2156 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2157 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2158 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2159
2160 case SHT_SHLIB:
2161 return TRUE;
2162
2163 case SHT_GROUP:
2164 /* We need a BFD section for objcopy and relocatable linking,
2165 and it's handy to have the signature available as the section
2166 name. */
2167 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr))
2168 return FALSE;
2169 name = group_signature (abfd, hdr);
2170 if (name == NULL)
2171 return FALSE;
2172 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2173 return FALSE;
2174 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
2175 {
2176 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
2177 unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
2178 asection *s;
2179
2180 if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
2181 hdr->bfd_section->flags
2182 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
2183
2184 /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in. */
2185 idx += n_elt;
2186 while (--n_elt != 0)
2187 {
2188 --idx;
2189
2190 if (idx->shdr != NULL
2191 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
2192 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
2193 {
2194 elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
2195 break;
2196 }
2197 }
2198 }
2199 break;
2200
2201 default:
2202 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2203 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2204 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2205 {
2206 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2207 return FALSE;
2208 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2209 return TRUE;
2210 }
2211
2212 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2213 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2214 return TRUE;
2215
2216 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2217 {
2218 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2219 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2220 for applications? */
2221 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2222 (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
2223 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2224 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2225 else
2226 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2227 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2228 shindex);
2229 }
2230 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2231 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2232 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2233 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2234 (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
2235 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2236 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2237 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2238 {
2239 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2240 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2241 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2242 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2243 be rejected with an error message. */
2244 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2245 (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
2246 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2247 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2248 else
2249 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2250 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2251 }
2252 else
2253 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2254 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2255 (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2256 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2257
2258 return FALSE;
2259 }
2260
2261 return TRUE;
2262 }
2263
2264 /* Return the section for the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX.
2265 Return SEC for sections that have no elf section, and NULL on error. */
2266
2267 asection *
2268 bfd_section_from_r_symndx (bfd *abfd,
2269 struct sym_sec_cache *cache,
2270 asection *sec,
2271 unsigned long r_symndx)
2272 {
2273 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2274 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2275 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2276 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
2277 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2278
2279 if (cache->abfd == abfd && cache->indx[ent] == r_symndx)
2280 return cache->sec[ent];
2281
2282 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2283 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2284 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2285 return NULL;
2286
2287 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2288 {
2289 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2290 cache->abfd = abfd;
2291 }
2292 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2293 cache->sec[ent] = sec;
2294 if ((isym.st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && isym.st_shndx < SHN_LORESERVE)
2295 || isym.st_shndx > SHN_HIRESERVE)
2296 {
2297 asection *s;
2298 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym.st_shndx);
2299 if (s != NULL)
2300 cache->sec[ent] = s;
2301 }
2302 return cache->sec[ent];
2303 }
2304
2305 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2306 section. */
2307
2308 asection *
2309 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int index)
2310 {
2311 if (index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2312 return NULL;
2313 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[index]->bfd_section;
2314 }
2315
2316 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2317 {
2318 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2319 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2320 };
2321
2322 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2323 {
2324 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2325 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2326 };
2327
2328 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2329 {
2330 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2331 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2332 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2333 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2334 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2335 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2336 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2337 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2338 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2339 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2340 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2341 };
2342
2343 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2344 {
2345 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2346 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2347 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2348 };
2349
2350 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2351 {
2352 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2353 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2354 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2355 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2356 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2357 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2358 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2359 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2360 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2361 };
2362
2363 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2364 {
2365 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2366 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2367 };
2368
2369 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2370 {
2371 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2372 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2373 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2374 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2375 };
2376
2377 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2378 {
2379 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2380 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2381 };
2382
2383 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2384 {
2385 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2386 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2387 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2388 };
2389
2390 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2391 {
2392 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2393 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2394 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2395 };
2396
2397 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2398 {
2399 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2400 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2401 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2402 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2403 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2404 };
2405
2406 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2407 {
2408 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2409 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2410 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2411 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2412 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2413 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2414 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2415 };
2416
2417 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2418 {
2419 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2420 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2421 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2422 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2423 };
2424
2425 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *special_sections[] =
2426 {
2427 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2428 special_sections_c, /* 'b' */
2429 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2430 NULL, /* 'e' */
2431 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2432 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2433 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2434 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2435 NULL, /* 'j' */
2436 NULL, /* 'k' */
2437 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2438 NULL, /* 'm' */
2439 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2440 NULL, /* 'o' */
2441 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2442 NULL, /* 'q' */
2443 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2444 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2445 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2446 };
2447
2448 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2449 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2450 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2451 unsigned int rela)
2452 {
2453 int i;
2454 int len;
2455
2456 len = strlen (name);
2457
2458 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2459 {
2460 int suffix_len;
2461 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2462
2463 if (len < prefix_len)
2464 continue;
2465 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2466 continue;
2467
2468 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2469 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2470 {
2471 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2472 {
2473 if (suffix_len == 0)
2474 continue;
2475 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2476 && (suffix_len == -2
2477 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2478 continue;
2479 }
2480 }
2481 else
2482 {
2483 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2484 continue;
2485 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2486 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2487 suffix_len) != 0)
2488 continue;
2489 }
2490 return &spec[i];
2491 }
2492
2493 return NULL;
2494 }
2495
2496 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2497 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2498 {
2499 int i;
2500 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2501 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2502
2503 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2504 if (sec->name == NULL)
2505 return NULL;
2506
2507 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2508 spec = bed->special_sections;
2509 if (spec)
2510 {
2511 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2512 bed->special_sections,
2513 sec->use_rela_p);
2514 if (spec != NULL)
2515 return spec;
2516 }
2517
2518 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2519 return NULL;
2520
2521 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2522 if (i < 0 || i > 't' - 'b')
2523 return NULL;
2524
2525 spec = special_sections[i];
2526
2527 if (spec == NULL)
2528 return NULL;
2529
2530 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2531 }
2532
2533 bfd_boolean
2534 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2535 {
2536 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2537 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2538 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2539
2540 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2541 if (sdata == NULL)
2542 {
2543 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*sdata));
2544 if (sdata == NULL)
2545 return FALSE;
2546 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2547 }
2548
2549 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2550 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2551 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2552
2553 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2554 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2555 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2556 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2557 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2558 elf_fake_sections. */
2559 if ((!sec->flags && abfd->direction != read_direction)
2560 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2561 {
2562 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2563 if (ssect != NULL)
2564 {
2565 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2566 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2567 }
2568 }
2569
2570 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2571 }
2572
2573 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2574
2575 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2576 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2577 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2578 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2579
2580 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2581 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2582 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2583 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2584 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2585 of combined data+bss.
2586
2587 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2588 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2589 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2590 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2591 into it's initialized and uninitialized parts.
2592
2593 */
2594
2595 bfd_boolean
2596 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2597 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2598 int index,
2599 const char *typename)
2600 {
2601 asection *newsect;
2602 char *name;
2603 char namebuf[64];
2604 size_t len;
2605 int split;
2606
2607 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2608 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2609 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2610 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", typename, index, split ? "a" : "");
2611 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2612 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2613 if (!name)
2614 return FALSE;
2615 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2616 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2617 if (newsect == NULL)
2618 return FALSE;
2619 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2620 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2621 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2622 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2623 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2624 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2625 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2626 {
2627 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2628 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2629 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2630 {
2631 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2632 may be data. */
2633 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2634 }
2635 }
2636 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2637 {
2638 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2639 }
2640
2641 if (split)
2642 {
2643 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%db", typename, index);
2644 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2645 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2646 if (!name)
2647 return FALSE;
2648 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2649 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2650 if (newsect == NULL)
2651 return FALSE;
2652 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2653 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2654 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2655 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2656 {
2657 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2658 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2659 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2660 }
2661 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2662 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2663 }
2664
2665 return TRUE;
2666 }
2667
2668 bfd_boolean
2669 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int index)
2670 {
2671 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2672
2673 switch (hdr->p_type)
2674 {
2675 case PT_NULL:
2676 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "null");
2677
2678 case PT_LOAD:
2679 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "load");
2680
2681 case PT_DYNAMIC:
2682 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "dynamic");
2683
2684 case PT_INTERP:
2685 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "interp");
2686
2687 case PT_NOTE:
2688 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "note"))
2689 return FALSE;
2690 if (! elfcore_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2691 return FALSE;
2692 return TRUE;
2693
2694 case PT_SHLIB:
2695 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "shlib");
2696
2697 case PT_PHDR:
2698 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "phdr");
2699
2700 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
2701 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index,
2702 "eh_frame_hdr");
2703
2704 case PT_GNU_STACK:
2705 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "stack");
2706
2707 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
2708 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "relro");
2709
2710 default:
2711 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
2712 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2713 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, index, "proc");
2714 }
2715 }
2716
2717 /* Initialize REL_HDR, the section-header for new section, containing
2718 relocations against ASECT. If USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA
2719 relocations; otherwise, we use REL relocations. */
2720
2721 bfd_boolean
2722 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
2723 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
2724 asection *asect,
2725 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
2726 {
2727 char *name;
2728 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2729 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof ".rela" + strlen (asect->name);
2730
2731 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2732 if (name == NULL)
2733 return FALSE;
2734 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", asect->name);
2735 rel_hdr->sh_name =
2736 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
2737 FALSE);
2738 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2739 return FALSE;
2740 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
2741 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
2742 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
2743 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
2744 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
2745 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
2746 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2747 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2748 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2749
2750 return TRUE;
2751 }
2752
2753 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
2754
2755 static void
2756 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *failedptrarg)
2757 {
2758 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2759 bfd_boolean *failedptr = failedptrarg;
2760 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
2761 unsigned int sh_type;
2762
2763 if (*failedptr)
2764 {
2765 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
2766 loop. */
2767 return;
2768 }
2769
2770 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (asect)->this_hdr;
2771
2772 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
2773 asect->name, FALSE);
2774 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
2775 {
2776 *failedptr = TRUE;
2777 return;
2778 }
2779
2780 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
2781
2782 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2783 || asect->user_set_vma)
2784 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
2785 else
2786 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
2787
2788 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
2789 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
2790 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
2791 this_hdr->sh_addralign = 1 << asect->alignment_power;
2792 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
2793 copy_private_section_data. */
2794
2795 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
2796 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
2797
2798 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
2799 asect->flags. */
2800 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
2801 {
2802 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
2803 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
2804 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2805 && (((asect->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
2806 || (asect->flags & SEC_NEVER_LOAD) != 0))
2807 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
2808 else
2809 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
2810 }
2811
2812 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
2813 {
2814 default:
2815 break;
2816
2817 case SHT_STRTAB:
2818 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
2819 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
2820 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
2821 case SHT_NOTE:
2822 case SHT_NOBITS:
2823 case SHT_PROGBITS:
2824 break;
2825
2826 case SHT_HASH:
2827 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
2828 break;
2829
2830 case SHT_DYNSYM:
2831 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
2832 break;
2833
2834 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
2835 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
2836 break;
2837
2838 case SHT_RELA:
2839 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
2840 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
2841 break;
2842
2843 case SHT_REL:
2844 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
2845 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
2846 break;
2847
2848 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2849 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
2850 break;
2851
2852 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2853 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2854 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2855 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
2856 zero. */
2857 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2858 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
2859 else
2860 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
2861 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
2862 break;
2863
2864 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2865 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
2866 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
2867 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
2868 zero. */
2869 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
2870 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
2871 else
2872 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
2873 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
2874 break;
2875
2876 case SHT_GROUP:
2877 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
2878 break;
2879
2880 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
2881 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
2882 break;
2883 }
2884
2885 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
2886 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
2887 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
2888 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
2889 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2890 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
2891 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
2892 {
2893 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
2894 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
2895 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
2896 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
2897 }
2898 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
2899 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
2900 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
2901 {
2902 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
2903 if (asect->size == 0
2904 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
2905 {
2906 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
2907
2908 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
2909 if (o != NULL)
2910 {
2911 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
2912 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
2913 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
2914 }
2915 }
2916 }
2917
2918 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
2919 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
2920 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
2921 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
2922 *failedptr = TRUE;
2923
2924 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
2925 {
2926 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
2927 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
2928 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
2929 }
2930
2931 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
2932 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
2933 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
2934 create the other. */
2935 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0
2936 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
2937 &elf_section_data (asect)->rel_hdr,
2938 asect,
2939 asect->use_rela_p))
2940 *failedptr = TRUE;
2941 }
2942
2943 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. */
2944
2945 void
2946 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
2947 {
2948 bfd_boolean *failedptr = failedptrarg;
2949 unsigned long symindx;
2950 asection *elt, *first;
2951 unsigned char *loc;
2952 bfd_boolean gas;
2953
2954 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
2955 elfxx-ia64.c. */
2956 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
2957 || *failedptr)
2958 return;
2959
2960 symindx = 0;
2961 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
2962 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
2963
2964 if (symindx == 0)
2965 {
2966 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
2967 elf_section_syms; If called for "ld -r", use target_index. */
2968 if (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL)
2969 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
2970 else
2971 symindx = sec->target_index;
2972 }
2973 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
2974
2975 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
2976 gas = TRUE;
2977 if (sec->contents == NULL)
2978 {
2979 gas = FALSE;
2980 sec->contents = bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
2981
2982 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
2983 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
2984 if (sec->contents == NULL)
2985 {
2986 *failedptr = TRUE;
2987 return;
2988 }
2989 }
2990
2991 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
2992
2993 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
2994 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
2995 start of the input section group. */
2996 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
2997
2998 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
2999 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3000 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3001 directives, not that it matters. */
3002 while (elt != NULL)
3003 {
3004 asection *s;
3005 unsigned int idx;
3006
3007 loc -= 4;
3008 s = elt;
3009 if (!gas)
3010 s = s->output_section;
3011 idx = 0;
3012 if (s != NULL)
3013 idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3014 H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
3015 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3016 if (elt == first)
3017 break;
3018 }
3019
3020 if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
3021 abort ();
3022
3023 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3024 }
3025
3026 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3027 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3028 in here too, while we're at it. */
3029
3030 static bfd_boolean
3031 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3032 {
3033 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3034 asection *sec;
3035 unsigned int section_number, secn;
3036 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3037 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3038
3039 section_number = 1;
3040
3041 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3042
3043 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3044 if (link_info == NULL || link_info->relocatable)
3045 {
3046 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3047 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3048 {
3049 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3050
3051 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3052 {
3053 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3054 {
3055 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3056 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3057 abfd->section_count--;
3058 }
3059 else
3060 {
3061 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3062 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3063 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3064 }
3065 }
3066 }
3067 }
3068
3069 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3070 {
3071 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3072
3073 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3074 {
3075 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3076 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3077 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3078 }
3079 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3080 if ((sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0)
3081 d->rel_idx = 0;
3082 else
3083 {
3084 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3085 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3086 d->rel_idx = section_number++;
3087 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel_hdr.sh_name);
3088 }
3089
3090 if (d->rel_hdr2)
3091 {
3092 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3093 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3094 d->rel_idx2 = section_number++;
3095 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel_hdr2->sh_name);
3096 }
3097 else
3098 d->rel_idx2 = 0;
3099 }
3100
3101 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3102 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3103 t->shstrtab_section = section_number++;
3104 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3105 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = t->shstrtab_section;
3106
3107 if (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0)
3108 {
3109 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3110 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3111 t->symtab_section = section_number++;
3112 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3113 if (section_number > SHN_LORESERVE - 2)
3114 {
3115 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3116 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3117 t->symtab_shndx_section = section_number++;
3118 t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name
3119 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3120 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3121 if (t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3122 return FALSE;
3123 }
3124 if (section_number == SHN_LORESERVE)
3125 section_number += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3126 t->strtab_section = section_number++;
3127 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3128 }
3129
3130 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3131 t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3132
3133 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3134 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3135 if (section_number > SHN_LORESERVE)
3136 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum -= SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
3137
3138 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3139 indices. */
3140 i_shdrp = bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3141 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3142 return FALSE;
3143
3144 i_shdrp[0] = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3145 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3146 {
3147 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3148 return FALSE;
3149 }
3150
3151 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3152
3153 i_shdrp[t->shstrtab_section] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3154 if (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0)
3155 {
3156 i_shdrp[t->symtab_section] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3157 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > SHN_LORESERVE)
3158 {
3159 i_shdrp[t->symtab_shndx_section] = &t->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3160 t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3161 }
3162 i_shdrp[t->strtab_section] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3163 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = t->strtab_section;
3164 }
3165
3166 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3167 {
3168 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d = elf_section_data (sec);
3169 asection *s;
3170 const char *name;
3171
3172 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3173 if (d->rel_idx != 0)
3174 i_shdrp[d->rel_idx] = &d->rel_hdr;
3175 if (d->rel_idx2 != 0)
3176 i_shdrp[d->rel_idx2] = d->rel_hdr2;
3177
3178 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3179
3180 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3181 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3182 the relocation entries apply. */
3183 if (d->rel_idx != 0)
3184 {
3185 d->rel_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3186 d->rel_hdr.sh_info = d->this_idx;
3187 }
3188 if (d->rel_idx2 != 0)
3189 {
3190 d->rel_hdr2->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3191 d->rel_hdr2->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3192 }
3193
3194 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3195 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3196 {
3197 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3198 if (s)
3199 {
3200 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3201 if (link_info != NULL)
3202 {
3203 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3204 if (elf_discarded_section (s))
3205 {
3206 asection *kept;
3207 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3208 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3209 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3210 s, s->owner);
3211 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3212 size as the discarded one. */
3213 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3214 if (kept == NULL)
3215 {
3216 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3217 return FALSE;
3218 }
3219 s = kept;
3220 }
3221
3222 s = s->output_section;
3223 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3224 }
3225 else
3226 {
3227 /* Handle objcopy. */
3228 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3229 {
3230 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3231 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3232 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3233 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3234 return FALSE;
3235 }
3236 s = s->output_section;
3237 }
3238 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3239 }
3240 else
3241 {
3242 /* PR 290:
3243 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3244 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3245 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3246 where s is NULL. */
3247 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3248 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3249 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3250 bed->link_order_error_handler
3251 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3252 abfd, sec);
3253 }
3254 }
3255
3256 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3257 {
3258 case SHT_REL:
3259 case SHT_RELA:
3260 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3261 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3262 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3263 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3264 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3265 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3266 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3267 if (s != NULL)
3268 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3269
3270 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3271 name = sec->name;
3272 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL)
3273 name += 4;
3274 else
3275 name += 5;
3276 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3277 if (s != NULL)
3278 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3279 break;
3280
3281 case SHT_STRTAB:
3282 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3283 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3284 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3285 field to point to this section. */
3286 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3287 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3288 {
3289 size_t len;
3290 char *alc;
3291
3292 len = strlen (sec->name);
3293 alc = bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3294 if (alc == NULL)
3295 return FALSE;
3296 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3297 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3298 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3299 free (alc);
3300 if (s != NULL)
3301 {
3302 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3303
3304 /* This is a .stab section. */
3305 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3306 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3307 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3308 }
3309 }
3310 break;
3311
3312 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3313 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3314 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3315 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3316 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3317 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3318 version strings. */
3319 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3320 if (s != NULL)
3321 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3322 break;
3323
3324 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3325 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3326 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3327 the version strings. */
3328 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3329 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3330 if (s != NULL)
3331 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3332 break;
3333
3334 case SHT_HASH:
3335 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3336 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3337 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3338 this hash table or version table is for. */
3339 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3340 if (s != NULL)
3341 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3342 break;
3343
3344 case SHT_GROUP:
3345 d->this_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
3346 }
3347 }
3348
3349 for (secn = 1; secn < section_number; ++secn)
3350 if (i_shdrp[secn] == NULL)
3351 i_shdrp[secn] = i_shdrp[0];
3352 else
3353 i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3354 i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name);
3355 return TRUE;
3356 }
3357
3358 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3359 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
3360
3361 static bfd_boolean
3362 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3363 {
3364 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3365 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3366 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3367 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3368
3369 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
3370 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3371 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3372 }
3373
3374 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3375 output. Also, don't output section symbols for reloc and other
3376 special sections. */
3377
3378 static bfd_boolean
3379 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3380 {
3381 return ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3382 && (sym->value != 0
3383 || (sym->section->owner != abfd
3384 && (sym->section->output_section->owner != abfd
3385 || sym->section->output_offset != 0))));
3386 }
3387
3388 static bfd_boolean
3389 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd)
3390 {
3391 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3392 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3393 asymbol **sect_syms;
3394 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
3395 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
3396 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
3397 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
3398 int max_index = 0;
3399 unsigned int idx;
3400 asection *asect;
3401 asymbol **new_syms;
3402
3403 #ifdef DEBUG
3404 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
3405 fflush (stderr);
3406 #endif
3407
3408 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3409 {
3410 if (max_index < asect->index)
3411 max_index = asect->index;
3412 }
3413
3414 max_index++;
3415 sect_syms = bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
3416 if (sect_syms == NULL)
3417 return FALSE;
3418 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
3419 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
3420
3421 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
3422 decided to output. */
3423 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3424 {
3425 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3426
3427 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
3428 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3429 {
3430 asection *sec = sym->section;
3431
3432 if (sec->owner != abfd)
3433 sec = sec->output_section;
3434
3435 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
3436 }
3437 }
3438
3439 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
3440 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3441 {
3442 if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
3443 continue;
3444 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
3445 num_locals++;
3446 else
3447 num_globals++;
3448 }
3449
3450 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
3451 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
3452 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
3453 at least in that case. */
3454 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3455 {
3456 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3457 {
3458 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
3459 num_locals++;
3460 else
3461 num_globals++;
3462 }
3463 }
3464
3465 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
3466 new_syms = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals, sizeof (asymbol *));
3467
3468 if (new_syms == NULL)
3469 return FALSE;
3470
3471 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
3472 {
3473 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
3474 unsigned int i;
3475
3476 if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
3477 continue;
3478 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3479 i = num_locals2++;
3480 else
3481 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3482 new_syms[i] = sym;
3483 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3484 }
3485 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
3486 {
3487 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
3488 {
3489 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
3490 unsigned int i;
3491
3492 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
3493 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3494 i = num_locals2++;
3495 else
3496 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
3497 new_syms[i] = sym;
3498 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
3499 }
3500 }
3501
3502 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
3503
3504 elf_num_locals (abfd) = num_locals;
3505 elf_num_globals (abfd) = num_globals;
3506 return TRUE;
3507 }
3508
3509 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
3510 ELF data structure. */
3511
3512 static inline file_ptr
3513 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
3514 {
3515 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
3516 }
3517
3518 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
3519 required section alignment. */
3520
3521 file_ptr
3522 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
3523 file_ptr offset,
3524 bfd_boolean align)
3525 {
3526 if (align)
3527 {
3528 unsigned int al;
3529
3530 al = i_shdrp->sh_addralign;
3531 if (al > 1)
3532 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, al);
3533 }
3534 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
3535 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
3536 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
3537 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
3538 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
3539 return offset;
3540 }
3541
3542 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
3543 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
3544 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
3545
3546 bfd_boolean
3547 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
3548 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3549 {
3550 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3551 bfd_boolean failed;
3552 struct bfd_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
3553 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
3554
3555 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
3556 return TRUE;
3557
3558 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
3559 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
3560 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
3561
3562 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
3563 return FALSE;
3564
3565 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
3566 if (bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers)
3567 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
3568
3569 failed = FALSE;
3570 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &failed);
3571 if (failed)
3572 return FALSE;
3573
3574 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
3575 return FALSE;
3576
3577 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
3578 if (link_info == NULL && bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0)
3579 {
3580 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
3581 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
3582
3583 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
3584 return FALSE;
3585 }
3586
3587 if (link_info == NULL)
3588 {
3589 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
3590 if (failed)
3591 return FALSE;
3592 }
3593
3594 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
3595 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
3596 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
3597 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3598 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3599 shstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3600 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3601 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3602 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
3603 /* sh_offset is set in assign_file_positions_except_relocs. */
3604 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
3605
3606 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
3607 return FALSE;
3608
3609 if (link_info == NULL && bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0)
3610 {
3611 file_ptr off;
3612 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
3613
3614 off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
3615
3616 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
3617 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3618
3619 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
3620 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
3621 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3622
3623 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
3624 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
3625
3626 elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
3627
3628 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
3629 out. */
3630 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
3631 || ! _bfd_stringtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
3632 return FALSE;
3633 _bfd_stringtab_free (strtab);
3634 }
3635
3636 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
3637
3638 return TRUE;
3639 }
3640
3641 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
3642 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
3643
3644 static bfd_size_type
3645 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3646 {
3647 size_t segs;
3648 asection *s;
3649 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3650
3651 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
3652 and one for data. */
3653 segs = 2;
3654
3655 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3656 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3657 {
3658 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
3659 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
3660 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
3661 targets. */
3662 segs += 2;
3663 }
3664
3665 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
3666 {
3667 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
3668 ++segs;
3669
3670 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->relro)
3671 {
3672 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when there is a
3673 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
3674 ++segs;
3675 }
3676 }
3677
3678 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr)
3679 {
3680 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
3681 ++segs;
3682 }
3683
3684 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
3685 {
3686 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
3687 ++segs;
3688 }
3689
3690 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3691 {
3692 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
3693 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
3694 {
3695 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
3696 ++segs;
3697 }
3698 }
3699
3700 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3701 {
3702 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
3703 {
3704 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
3705 ++segs;
3706 break;
3707 }
3708 }
3709
3710 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
3711 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3712 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
3713 {
3714 int a;
3715
3716 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
3717 if (a == -1)
3718 abort ();
3719 segs += a;
3720 }
3721
3722 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
3723 }
3724
3725 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
3726
3727 static struct elf_segment_map *
3728 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
3729 asection **sections,
3730 unsigned int from,
3731 unsigned int to,
3732 bfd_boolean phdr)
3733 {
3734 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3735 unsigned int i;
3736 asection **hdrpp;
3737 bfd_size_type amt;
3738
3739 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3740 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
3741 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3742 if (m == NULL)
3743 return NULL;
3744 m->next = NULL;
3745 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
3746 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
3747 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
3748 m->count = to - from;
3749
3750 if (from == 0 && phdr)
3751 {
3752 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
3753 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
3754 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3755 }
3756
3757 return m;
3758 }
3759
3760 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
3761 on failure. */
3762
3763 struct elf_segment_map *
3764 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
3765 {
3766 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3767
3768 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
3769 if (m == NULL)
3770 return NULL;
3771 m->next = NULL;
3772 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
3773 m->count = 1;
3774 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
3775
3776 return m;
3777 }
3778
3779 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
3780
3781 static bfd_boolean
3782 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3783 {
3784 struct elf_segment_map **m;
3785 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3786
3787 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
3788 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
3789 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
3790 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
3791 removed. */
3792 m = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
3793 while (*m)
3794 {
3795 unsigned int i, new_count;
3796
3797 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
3798 {
3799 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3800 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3801 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
3802 {
3803 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
3804 new_count++;
3805 }
3806 }
3807 (*m)->count = new_count;
3808
3809 if ((*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
3810 *m = (*m)->next;
3811 else
3812 m = &(*m)->next;
3813 }
3814
3815 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3816 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
3817 {
3818 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
3819 return FALSE;
3820 }
3821
3822 return TRUE;
3823 }
3824
3825 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
3826
3827 bfd_boolean
3828 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3829 {
3830 unsigned int count;
3831 struct elf_segment_map *m;
3832 asection **sections = NULL;
3833 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3834
3835 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map == NULL
3836 && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
3837 {
3838 asection *s;
3839 unsigned int i;
3840 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
3841 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
3842 asection *last_hdr;
3843 bfd_vma last_size;
3844 unsigned int phdr_index;
3845 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
3846 asection **hdrpp;
3847 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
3848 bfd_boolean writable;
3849 int tls_count = 0;
3850 asection *first_tls = NULL;
3851 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
3852 bfd_size_type amt;
3853
3854 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
3855
3856 sections = bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd), sizeof (asection *));
3857 if (sections == NULL)
3858 goto error_return;
3859
3860 i = 0;
3861 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
3862 {
3863 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3864 {
3865 sections[i] = s;
3866 ++i;
3867 }
3868 }
3869 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
3870 count = i;
3871
3872 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
3873
3874 /* Build the mapping. */
3875
3876 mfirst = NULL;
3877 pm = &mfirst;
3878
3879 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
3880 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
3881 section. */
3882 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
3883 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
3884 {
3885 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3886 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3887 if (m == NULL)
3888 goto error_return;
3889 m->next = NULL;
3890 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
3891 /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not. */
3892 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
3893 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
3894 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
3895
3896 *pm = m;
3897 pm = &m->next;
3898
3899 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
3900 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3901 if (m == NULL)
3902 goto error_return;
3903 m->next = NULL;
3904 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
3905 m->count = 1;
3906 m->sections[0] = s;
3907
3908 *pm = m;
3909 pm = &m->next;
3910 }
3911
3912 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
3913 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
3914 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
3915 last_hdr = NULL;
3916 last_size = 0;
3917 phdr_index = 0;
3918 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
3919 writable = FALSE;
3920 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
3921 if (dynsec != NULL
3922 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
3923 dynsec = NULL;
3924
3925 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
3926 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
3927 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
3928 program headers we will need. */
3929 if (count > 0)
3930 {
3931 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
3932
3933 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
3934 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
3935 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
3936 || sections[0]->lma < phdr_size
3937 || sections[0]->lma % maxpagesize < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
3938 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
3939 }
3940
3941 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
3942 {
3943 asection *hdr;
3944 bfd_boolean new_segment;
3945
3946 hdr = *hdrpp;
3947
3948 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
3949 segment. */
3950
3951 if (last_hdr == NULL)
3952 {
3953 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
3954 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
3955 new_segment = FALSE;
3956 }
3957 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
3958 {
3959 /* If this section has a different relation between the
3960 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
3961 segment. */
3962 new_segment = TRUE;
3963 }
3964 else if (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
3965 < BFD_ALIGN (hdr->lma, maxpagesize))
3966 {
3967 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
3968 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
3969 new_segment = TRUE;
3970 }
3971 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
3972 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
3973 {
3974 /* We don't want to put a loadable section after a
3975 nonloadable section in the same segment.
3976 Consider .tbss sections as loadable for this purpose. */
3977 new_segment = TRUE;
3978 }
3979 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
3980 {
3981 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
3982 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
3983 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
3984 new_segment = FALSE;
3985 }
3986 else if (! writable
3987 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
3988 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1)
3989 & ~(maxpagesize - 1))
3990 != (hdr->lma & ~(maxpagesize - 1))))
3991 {
3992 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
3993 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
3994 anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
3995 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
3996 only case in which the new section is not on the same
3997 page as the previous section is when the previous section
3998 ends precisely on a page boundary. */
3999 new_segment = TRUE;
4000 }
4001 else
4002 {
4003 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4004 new_segment = FALSE;
4005 }
4006
4007 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4008 if (last_hdr && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment)
4009 new_segment = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr, last_hdr, new_segment);
4010
4011 if (! new_segment)
4012 {
4013 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4014 writable = TRUE;
4015 last_hdr = hdr;
4016 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4017 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4018 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4019 last_size = hdr->size;
4020 else
4021 last_size = 0;
4022 continue;
4023 }
4024
4025 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4026 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4027
4028 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4029 if (m == NULL)
4030 goto error_return;
4031
4032 *pm = m;
4033 pm = &m->next;
4034
4035 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4036 writable = TRUE;
4037 else
4038 writable = FALSE;
4039
4040 last_hdr = hdr;
4041 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4042 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4043 last_size = hdr->size;
4044 else
4045 last_size = 0;
4046 phdr_index = i;
4047 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4048 }
4049
4050 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment. */
4051 if (last_hdr != NULL)
4052 {
4053 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4054 if (m == NULL)
4055 goto error_return;
4056
4057 *pm = m;
4058 pm = &m->next;
4059 }
4060
4061 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4062 if (dynsec != NULL)
4063 {
4064 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4065 if (m == NULL)
4066 goto error_return;
4067 *pm = m;
4068 pm = &m->next;
4069 }
4070
4071 /* For each loadable .note section, add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't
4072 use bfd_get_section_by_name, because if we link together
4073 nonloadable .note sections and loadable .note sections, we will
4074 generate two .note sections in the output file. FIXME: Using
4075 names for section types is bogus anyhow. */
4076 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4077 {
4078 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4079 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4080 {
4081 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4082 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4083 if (m == NULL)
4084 goto error_return;
4085 m->next = NULL;
4086 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4087 m->count = 1;
4088 m->sections[0] = s;
4089
4090 *pm = m;
4091 pm = &m->next;
4092 }
4093 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4094 {
4095 if (! tls_count)
4096 first_tls = s;
4097 tls_count++;
4098 }
4099 }
4100
4101 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4102 if (tls_count > 0)
4103 {
4104 int i;
4105
4106 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4107 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4108 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4109 if (m == NULL)
4110 goto error_return;
4111 m->next = NULL;
4112 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4113 m->count = tls_count;
4114 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4115 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4116 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4117 for (i = 0; i < tls_count; ++i)
4118 {
4119 BFD_ASSERT (first_tls->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL);
4120 m->sections[i] = first_tls;
4121 first_tls = first_tls->next;
4122 }
4123
4124 *pm = m;
4125 pm = &m->next;
4126 }
4127
4128 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4129 segment. */
4130 eh_frame_hdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr;
4131 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4132 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4133 {
4134 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4135 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4136 if (m == NULL)
4137 goto error_return;
4138 m->next = NULL;
4139 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4140 m->count = 1;
4141 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4142
4143 *pm = m;
4144 pm = &m->next;
4145 }
4146
4147 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
4148 {
4149 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4150 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4151 if (m == NULL)
4152 goto error_return;
4153 m->next = NULL;
4154 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4155 m->p_flags = elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags;
4156 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4157
4158 *pm = m;
4159 pm = &m->next;
4160 }
4161
4162 if (dynsec != NULL && elf_tdata (abfd)->relro)
4163 {
4164 /* We make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when there is a
4165 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4166 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4167 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4168 if (m == NULL)
4169 goto error_return;
4170 m->next = NULL;
4171 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
4172 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4173 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4174
4175 *pm = m;
4176 pm = &m->next;
4177 }
4178
4179 free (sections);
4180 elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map = mfirst;
4181 }
4182
4183 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info))
4184 return FALSE;
4185
4186 for (count = 0, m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4187 ++count;
4188 elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4189
4190 return TRUE;
4191
4192 error_return:
4193 if (sections != NULL)
4194 free (sections);
4195 return FALSE;
4196 }
4197
4198 /* Sort sections by address. */
4199
4200 static int
4201 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
4202 {
4203 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
4204 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
4205 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
4206
4207 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
4208 place the section into a segment. */
4209 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
4210 return -1;
4211 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
4212 return 1;
4213
4214 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
4215 the same, and this will do nothing. */
4216 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
4217 return -1;
4218 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
4219 return 1;
4220
4221 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
4222
4223 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
4224
4225 if (TOEND (sec1))
4226 {
4227 if (TOEND (sec2))
4228 {
4229 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
4230 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
4231 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
4232 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4233 }
4234 else
4235 return 1;
4236 }
4237 else if (TOEND (sec2))
4238 return -1;
4239
4240 #undef TOEND
4241
4242 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
4243 before others at the same address. */
4244
4245 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
4246 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
4247
4248 if (size1 < size2)
4249 return -1;
4250 if (size1 > size2)
4251 return 1;
4252
4253 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
4254 }
4255
4256 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
4257
4258 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
4259 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
4260 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
4261 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
4262 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
4263 which is wrong.
4264
4265 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
4266 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
4267 the page size.'' */
4268 /* In other words, something like:
4269
4270 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
4271 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
4272 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
4273 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
4274 else
4275 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
4276
4277 which can can be collapsed into the expression below. */
4278
4279 static file_ptr
4280 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
4281 {
4282 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
4283 }
4284
4285 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
4286 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
4287 the file header. */
4288
4289 static bfd_boolean
4290 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4291 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4292 {
4293 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4294 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4295 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4296 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4297 file_ptr off;
4298 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
4299 unsigned int alloc;
4300 unsigned int i, j;
4301
4302 if (link_info == NULL
4303 && !elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, link_info))
4304 return FALSE;
4305
4306 alloc = 0;
4307 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4308 ++alloc;
4309
4310 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4311 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4312 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
4313
4314 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4315 elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4316 else
4317 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size
4318 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
4319
4320 if (alloc == 0)
4321 {
4322 elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4323 return TRUE;
4324 }
4325
4326 phdrs = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, alloc, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
4327 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
4328 if (phdrs == NULL)
4329 return FALSE;
4330
4331 maxpagesize = 1;
4332 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4333 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4334
4335 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4336 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4337
4338 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs, j = 0;
4339 m != NULL;
4340 m = m->next, p++, j++)
4341 {
4342 asection **secpp;
4343 bfd_vma off_adjust;
4344 bfd_boolean no_contents;
4345
4346 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
4347 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
4348 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
4349 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
4350 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
4351 if (m->count > 1
4352 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
4353 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
4354 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
4355 elf_sort_sections);
4356
4357 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
4358 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
4359 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
4360 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
4361 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
4362 p->p_type = m->p_type;
4363 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
4364
4365 if (m->count == 0)
4366 p->p_vaddr = 0;
4367 else
4368 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4369
4370 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
4371 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
4372 else if (m->count == 0)
4373 p->p_paddr = 0;
4374 else
4375 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
4376
4377 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4378 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4379 {
4380 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
4381 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
4382 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
4383 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
4384 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
4385 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
4386 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
4387 segment. */
4388 if (m->p_align_valid)
4389 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
4390
4391 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
4392 }
4393 else if (m->count == 0)
4394 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
4395 else if (m->p_align_valid)
4396 p->p_align = m->p_align;
4397 else
4398 p->p_align = 0;
4399
4400 no_contents = FALSE;
4401 off_adjust = 0;
4402 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4403 && m->count > 0)
4404 {
4405 bfd_size_type align;
4406 unsigned int align_power = 0;
4407
4408 if (m->p_align_valid)
4409 align = p->p_align;
4410 else
4411 {
4412 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4413 {
4414 unsigned int secalign;
4415
4416 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
4417 if (secalign > align_power)
4418 align_power = secalign;
4419 }
4420 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
4421 if (align < maxpagesize)
4422 align = maxpagesize;
4423 }
4424
4425 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
4426 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
4427 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
4428 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
4429 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
4430 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
4431
4432 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
4433 sections. If the first section isn't loadable, the same
4434 holds for any other sections. */
4435 i = 0;
4436 while (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) == SHT_NOBITS)
4437 {
4438 /* If a segment starts with .tbss, we need to look
4439 at the next section to decide whether the segment
4440 has any loadable sections. */
4441 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[i]) & SHF_TLS) == 0
4442 || ++i >= m->count)
4443 {
4444 no_contents = TRUE;
4445 break;
4446 }
4447 }
4448
4449 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (m->sections[0]->vma, off, align);
4450 off += off_adjust;
4451 if (no_contents)
4452 {
4453 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
4454 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
4455 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
4456 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
4457 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
4458 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
4459 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
4460 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
4461 }
4462 else
4463 off_adjust = 0;
4464 }
4465 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
4466 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4467 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
4468 && m->count > 1
4469 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
4470 {
4471 _bfd_error_handler
4472 (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
4473 abfd);
4474 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4475 return FALSE;
4476 }
4477
4478 p->p_offset = 0;
4479 p->p_filesz = 0;
4480 p->p_memsz = 0;
4481
4482 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4483 {
4484 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4485 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4486 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4487 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4488 if (m->count > 0)
4489 {
4490 BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
4491
4492 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
4493 {
4494 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4495 (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
4496 abfd);
4497 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4498 return FALSE;
4499 }
4500
4501 p->p_vaddr -= off;
4502 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4503 p->p_paddr -= off;
4504 }
4505 }
4506
4507 if (m->includes_phdrs)
4508 {
4509 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4510 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4511
4512 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
4513 {
4514 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4515
4516 if (m->count > 0)
4517 {
4518 BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
4519 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4520 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
4521 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
4522 }
4523 }
4524
4525 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4526 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4527 }
4528
4529 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4530 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
4531 {
4532 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
4533 p->p_offset = off;
4534 else
4535 {
4536 file_ptr adjust;
4537
4538 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
4539 if (!no_contents)
4540 p->p_filesz += adjust;
4541 p->p_memsz += adjust;
4542 }
4543 }
4544
4545 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
4546 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
4547 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
4548 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
4549 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
4550 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4551 {
4552 asection *sec;
4553 bfd_size_type align;
4554 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4555
4556 sec = *secpp;
4557 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
4558 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
4559
4560 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
4561 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4562 {
4563 bfd_signed_vma adjust = sec->lma - (p->p_paddr + p->p_memsz);
4564
4565 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
4566 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
4567 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
4568 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)))
4569 {
4570 if (adjust < 0)
4571 {
4572 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4573 (_("%B: section %A lma 0x%lx overlaps previous sections"),
4574 abfd, sec, (unsigned long) sec->lma);
4575 adjust = 0;
4576 }
4577 p->p_memsz += adjust;
4578
4579 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4580 {
4581 off += adjust;
4582 p->p_filesz += adjust;
4583 }
4584 }
4585 }
4586
4587 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
4588 {
4589 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
4590 everything. */
4591 if (i == 0)
4592 {
4593 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4594 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4595 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
4596 p->p_memsz = 0;
4597 p->p_align = 1;
4598 }
4599 else
4600 {
4601 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
4602 sec->filepos = 0;
4603 sec->size = 0;
4604 sec->flags = 0;
4605 continue;
4606 }
4607 }
4608 else
4609 {
4610 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
4611 {
4612 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
4613 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4614 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
4615 }
4616
4617 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4618 {
4619 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4620 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
4621 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
4622 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
4623 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4624 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4625 }
4626 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4627 {
4628 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
4629 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4630
4631 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
4632 normal segments. */
4633 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
4634 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
4635 }
4636
4637 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
4638 p->p_align = 1;
4639 else if (align > p->p_align
4640 && !m->p_align_valid
4641 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4642 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
4643 p->p_align = align;
4644 }
4645
4646 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
4647 {
4648 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
4649 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
4650 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
4651 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
4652 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
4653 }
4654 }
4655 off -= off_adjust;
4656
4657 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
4658 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
4659 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
4660 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
4661 {
4662 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
4663 asection *sec;
4664
4665 sec = *secpp;
4666 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
4667 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0
4668 && !ELF_IS_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_FILE (this_hdr, p))
4669 {
4670 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4671 (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
4672 abfd, sec, j);
4673 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4674 return FALSE;
4675 }
4676 }
4677 }
4678
4679 elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
4680 return TRUE;
4681 }
4682
4683 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
4684
4685 static bfd_boolean
4686 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
4687 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4688 {
4689 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4690 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
4691 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
4692 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
4693 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4694 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4695 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
4696 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
4697 file_ptr off;
4698 unsigned int num_sec;
4699 unsigned int i;
4700 unsigned int count;
4701
4702 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4703 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
4704 off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
4705 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
4706 {
4707 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
4708 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4709
4710 hdr = *hdrpp;
4711 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4712 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
4713 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
4714 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
4715 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
4716 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
4717 {
4718 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4719 ((*_bfd_error_handler)
4720 (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
4721 abfd,
4722 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
4723 ? "*unknown*"
4724 : hdr->bfd_section->name)));
4725 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
4726 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
4727 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4728 bed->maxpagesize);
4729 else
4730 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
4731 hdr->sh_addralign);
4732 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
4733 FALSE);
4734 }
4735 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
4736 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
4737 || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_section]
4738 || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_shndx_section]
4739 || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->strtab_section])
4740 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
4741 else
4742 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4743
4744 if (i == SHN_LORESERVE - 1)
4745 {
4746 i += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
4747 hdrpp += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
4748 }
4749 }
4750
4751 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
4752 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
4753 count = 0;
4754 filehdr_vaddr = 0;
4755 filehdr_paddr = 0;
4756 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4757 phdrs_paddr = 0;
4758 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4759 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
4760 m != NULL;
4761 m = m->next, p++)
4762 {
4763 ++count;
4764 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
4765 continue;
4766
4767 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4768 {
4769 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4770 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4771 }
4772 if (m->includes_phdrs)
4773 {
4774 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
4775 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
4776 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4777 {
4778 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4779 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4780 }
4781 }
4782 }
4783
4784 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
4785 m != NULL;
4786 m = m->next, p++)
4787 {
4788 if (m->count != 0)
4789 {
4790 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
4791 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
4792 {
4793 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4794 BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
4795
4796 hdr = &elf_section_data (m->sections[m->count - 1])->this_hdr;
4797 p->p_filesz = (m->sections[m->count - 1]->filepos
4798 - m->sections[0]->filepos);
4799 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4800 p->p_filesz += hdr->sh_size;
4801
4802 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
4803 }
4804 }
4805 else
4806 {
4807 if (m->includes_filehdr)
4808 {
4809 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
4810 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
4811 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
4812 }
4813 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
4814 {
4815 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
4816 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
4817 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
4818 }
4819 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
4820 {
4821 Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
4822
4823 for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
4824 {
4825 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
4826 && lp->p_vaddr <= link_info->relro_end
4827 && lp->p_vaddr >= link_info->relro_start
4828 && (lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz
4829 >= link_info->relro_end))
4830 break;
4831 }
4832
4833 if (lp < phdrs + count
4834 && link_info->relro_end > lp->p_vaddr)
4835 {
4836 p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
4837 p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
4838 p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
4839 p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
4840 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
4841 p->p_align = 1;
4842 p->p_flags = (lp->p_flags & ~PF_W);
4843 }
4844 else
4845 {
4846 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
4847 p->p_type = PT_NULL;
4848 }
4849 }
4850 }
4851 }
4852
4853 elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
4854
4855 return TRUE;
4856 }
4857
4858 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
4859 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
4860 VMAs must be known before this is called.
4861
4862 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
4863 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
4864 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
4865 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
4866 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
4867 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
4868 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
4869
4870 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
4871
4872 static bfd_boolean
4873 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
4874 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4875 {
4876 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
4877 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
4878 file_ptr off;
4879 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4880
4881 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
4882 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
4883 {
4884 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4885 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
4886 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
4887 unsigned int i;
4888
4889 /* Start after the ELF header. */
4890 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
4891
4892 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
4893 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
4894 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
4895 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
4896 {
4897 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4898
4899 hdr = *hdrpp;
4900 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
4901 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
4902 || i == tdata->symtab_section
4903 || i == tdata->symtab_shndx_section
4904 || i == tdata->strtab_section)
4905 {
4906 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
4907 }
4908 else
4909 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4910
4911 if (i == SHN_LORESERVE - 1)
4912 {
4913 i += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
4914 hdrpp += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
4915 }
4916 }
4917 }
4918 else
4919 {
4920 unsigned int alloc;
4921
4922 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
4923 assignment of sections to segments. */
4924 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
4925 return FALSE;
4926
4927 /* And for non-load sections. */
4928 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
4929 return FALSE;
4930
4931 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
4932 {
4933 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
4934 return FALSE;
4935 }
4936
4937 /* Write out the program headers. */
4938 alloc = tdata->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4939 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
4940 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
4941 return FALSE;
4942
4943 off = tdata->next_file_pos;
4944 }
4945
4946 /* Place the section headers. */
4947 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
4948 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
4949 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
4950
4951 tdata->next_file_pos = off;
4952
4953 return TRUE;
4954 }
4955
4956 static bfd_boolean
4957 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
4958 {
4959 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form */
4960 Elf_Internal_Phdr *i_phdrp = 0; /* Program header table, internal form */
4961 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp; /* Section header table, internal form */
4962 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
4963 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4964
4965 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
4966 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
4967
4968 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
4969 if (shstrtab == NULL)
4970 return FALSE;
4971
4972 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
4973
4974 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
4975 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
4976 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
4977 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
4978
4979 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
4980 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
4981 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
4982 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
4983
4984 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
4985 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
4986 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
4987 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
4988 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
4989 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
4990 else
4991 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
4992
4993 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
4994 {
4995 case bfd_arch_unknown:
4996 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
4997 break;
4998
4999 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
5000 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
5001 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
5002 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
5003 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
5004 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
5005 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
5006 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
5007 default:
5008 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
5009 }
5010
5011 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
5012 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5013
5014 /* No program header, for now. */
5015 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5016 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5017 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
5018
5019 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
5020 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
5021 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
5022
5023 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
5024 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
5025 /* It all happens later. */
5026 ;
5027 else
5028 {
5029 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
5030 i_phdrp = 0;
5031 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
5032 }
5033
5034 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
5035 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
5036 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
5037 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
5038 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
5039 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
5040 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5041 || elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
5042 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
5043 return FALSE;
5044
5045 return TRUE;
5046 }
5047
5048 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
5049 of the loadable file image. */
5050
5051 void
5052 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (bfd *abfd)
5053 {
5054 file_ptr off;
5055 unsigned int i, num_sec;
5056 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp;
5057
5058 off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
5059
5060 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5061 for (i = 1, shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1; i < num_sec; i++, shdrpp++)
5062 {
5063 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
5064
5065 shdrp = *shdrpp;
5066 if ((shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5067 && shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
5068 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
5069 }
5070
5071 elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
5072 }
5073
5074 bfd_boolean
5075 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
5076 {
5077 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5078 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
5079 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
5080 bfd_boolean failed;
5081 unsigned int count, num_sec;
5082
5083 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
5084 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
5085 return FALSE;
5086
5087 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5088 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5089
5090 failed = FALSE;
5091 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
5092 if (failed)
5093 return FALSE;
5094
5095 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (abfd);
5096
5097 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
5098 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5099 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
5100 {
5101 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
5102 (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
5103 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
5104 {
5105 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
5106
5107 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5108 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
5109 return FALSE;
5110 }
5111 if (count == SHN_LORESERVE - 1)
5112 count += SHN_HIRESERVE + 1 - SHN_LORESERVE;
5113 }
5114
5115 /* Write out the section header names. */
5116 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
5117 && (bfd_seek (abfd, elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
5118 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
5119 return FALSE;
5120
5121 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
5122 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd,
5123 elf_tdata (abfd)->linker);
5124
5125 return bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd);
5126 }
5127
5128 bfd_boolean
5129 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
5130 {
5131 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
5132 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
5133 }
5134
5135 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
5136
5137 int
5138 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
5139 {
5140 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5141 int index;
5142
5143 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
5144 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
5145 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
5146
5147 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
5148 index = SHN_ABS;
5149 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
5150 index = SHN_COMMON;
5151 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
5152 index = SHN_UNDEF;
5153 else
5154 index = -1;
5155
5156 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5157 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
5158 {
5159 int retval = index;
5160
5161 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
5162 return retval;
5163 }
5164
5165 if (index == -1)
5166 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
5167
5168 return index;
5169 }
5170
5171 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
5172 on error. */
5173
5174 int
5175 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
5176 {
5177 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
5178 int idx;
5179 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
5180
5181 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
5182 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
5183 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
5184 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
5185 input sections rather than the output section. */
5186 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
5187 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
5188 && asym_ptr->section)
5189 {
5190 asection *sec;
5191 int indx;
5192
5193 sec = asym_ptr->section;
5194 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
5195 sec = sec->output_section;
5196 if (sec->owner == abfd
5197 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
5198 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
5199 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
5200 }
5201
5202 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
5203
5204 if (idx == 0)
5205 {
5206 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
5207 which is used in a relocation entry. */
5208 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5209 (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
5210 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
5211 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
5212 return -1;
5213 }
5214
5215 #if DEBUG & 4
5216 {
5217 fprintf (stderr,
5218 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx%s\n",
5219 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags,
5220 elf_symbol_flags (flags));
5221 fflush (stderr);
5222 }
5223 #endif
5224
5225 return idx;
5226 }
5227
5228 /* Rewrite program header information. */
5229
5230 static bfd_boolean
5231 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5232 {
5233 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5234 struct elf_segment_map *map;
5235 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5236 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5237 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5238 asection *section;
5239 unsigned int i;
5240 unsigned int num_segments;
5241 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
5242 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
5243 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
5244 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
5245 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5246
5247 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
5248 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
5249
5250 map_first = NULL;
5251 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
5252
5253 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5254 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
5255
5256 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
5257 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
5258 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
5259 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
5260
5261 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
5262 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5263 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
5264 ? section->size : 0)
5265
5266 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5267 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
5268 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
5269 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
5270 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5271 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
5272
5273 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
5274 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
5275 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
5276 (section->lma >= base \
5277 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
5278 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
5279
5280 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo etc. */
5281 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
5282 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
5283 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
5284 && s->vma == 0 && s->lma == 0 \
5285 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5286 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5287 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5288
5289 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
5290 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
5291 p_memsz set to 0. */
5292 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
5293 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
5294 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
5295 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
5296 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
5297 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
5298 && s->size > 0 \
5299 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
5300 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
5301 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
5302
5303 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
5304 A section will be included if:
5305 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
5306 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
5307 2. It is an allocated segment,
5308 3. There is an output section associated with it,
5309 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
5310 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
5311 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
5312 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
5313 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
5314 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
5315 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
5316 ((((segment->p_paddr \
5317 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
5318 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
5319 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
5320 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)) \
5321 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
5322 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
5323 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
5324 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
5325 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
5326 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
5327 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
5328 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
5329 || (segment->p_paddr \
5330 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
5331 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
5332 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
5333 == 0)) \
5334 && ! section->segment_mark)
5335
5336 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
5337 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
5338 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
5339 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
5340 && section->output_section != NULL)
5341
5342 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
5343 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
5344 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
5345
5346 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
5347 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
5348 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
5349 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
5350 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
5351 LMA. */
5352 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
5353 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
5354 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
5355 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
5356 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
5357
5358 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
5359 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
5360 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
5361
5362 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
5363 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
5364 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
5365 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
5366 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5367 i < num_segments;
5368 i++, segment++)
5369 {
5370 unsigned int j;
5371 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
5372
5373 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
5374 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
5375 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
5376 {
5377 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
5378 assignment code will work. */
5379 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
5380 break;
5381 }
5382
5383 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5384 continue;
5385
5386 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
5387 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2 ++)
5388 {
5389 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
5390
5391 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
5392 || ! SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
5393 continue;
5394
5395 /* Merge the two segments together. */
5396 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
5397 {
5398 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
5399 SEGMENT. */
5400 extra_length =
5401 SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
5402 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr);
5403
5404 if (extra_length > 0)
5405 {
5406 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
5407 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
5408 }
5409
5410 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
5411
5412 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
5413 i = 0;
5414 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5415 break;
5416 }
5417 else
5418 {
5419 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
5420 SEGMENT2. */
5421 extra_length =
5422 SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
5423 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr);
5424
5425 if (extra_length > 0)
5426 {
5427 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
5428 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
5429 }
5430
5431 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
5432 }
5433 }
5434 }
5435
5436 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
5437 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5438 i < num_segments;
5439 i ++, segment ++)
5440 {
5441 unsigned int section_count;
5442 asection ** sections;
5443 asection * output_section;
5444 unsigned int isec;
5445 bfd_vma matching_lma;
5446 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
5447 unsigned int j;
5448 bfd_size_type amt;
5449 asection * first_section;
5450
5451 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
5452 continue;
5453
5454 first_section = NULL;
5455 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
5456 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
5457 section != NULL;
5458 section = section->next)
5459 {
5460 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
5461 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
5462 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5463 {
5464 if (first_section == NULL)
5465 first_section = section;
5466 if (section->output_section != NULL)
5467 ++section_count;
5468 }
5469 }
5470
5471 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
5472 all of the sections we have selected. */
5473 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5474 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5475 map = bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
5476 if (map == NULL)
5477 return FALSE;
5478
5479 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
5480 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
5481 map->next = NULL;
5482 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5483 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5484 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5485
5486 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
5487 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
5488 output segment. */
5489 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
5490 {
5491 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
5492 map->p_paddr_valid = 1;
5493 }
5494
5495 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
5496 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
5497 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
5498 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
5499
5500 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5501
5502 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5503 {
5504 map->includes_phdrs =
5505 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5506 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
5507 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5508 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
5509
5510 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
5511 phdr_included = TRUE;
5512 }
5513
5514 if (section_count == 0)
5515 {
5516 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
5517 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
5518 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
5519 a warning is produced. */
5520 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5521 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5522 (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected, is this intentional ?\n"),
5523 ibfd);
5524
5525 map->count = 0;
5526 *pointer_to_map = map;
5527 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5528
5529 continue;
5530 }
5531
5532 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
5533 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
5534 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
5535 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
5536
5537 1. None of the sections have been moved.
5538 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
5539 input BFD.
5540
5541 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
5542 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5543 of the first section.
5544
5545 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
5546 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
5547 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
5548 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
5549 have to be created to contain the other sections.
5550
5551 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
5552 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
5553 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
5554 or segments to contain the other sections.
5555
5556 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
5557 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
5558 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
5559
5560 /* Gcc 2.96 miscompiles this code on mips. Don't do casting here
5561 to work around this long long bug. */
5562 sections = bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
5563 if (sections == NULL)
5564 return FALSE;
5565
5566 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
5567 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
5568 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
5569 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
5570 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
5571 more to do. */
5572 isec = 0;
5573 matching_lma = 0;
5574 suggested_lma = 0;
5575
5576 for (j = 0, section = ibfd->sections;
5577 section != NULL;
5578 section = section->next)
5579 {
5580 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
5581 {
5582 output_section = section->output_section;
5583
5584 sections[j ++] = section;
5585
5586 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
5587 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
5588 correct value. Note - some backends require that
5589 p_paddr be left as zero. */
5590 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
5591 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
5592 && (! bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
5593 && isec == 0
5594 && output_section->lma != 0
5595 && (output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
5596 + (map->includes_filehdr
5597 ? iehdr->e_ehsize
5598 : 0)
5599 + (map->includes_phdrs
5600 ? (iehdr->e_phnum
5601 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
5602 : 0))))
5603 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
5604
5605 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
5606 LMA address of the output section. */
5607 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5608 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
5609 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero &&
5610 IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
5611 {
5612 if (matching_lma == 0)
5613 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
5614
5615 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
5616 then it does not overlap any other section within that
5617 segment. */
5618 map->sections[isec ++] = output_section;
5619 }
5620 else if (suggested_lma == 0)
5621 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5622 }
5623 }
5624
5625 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
5626
5627 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
5628 if necessary. */
5629 if (isec == section_count)
5630 {
5631 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
5632 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
5633 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
5634 program header in the input BFD. */
5635 map->count = section_count;
5636 *pointer_to_map = map;
5637 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5638
5639 if (matching_lma != map->p_paddr
5640 && !map->includes_filehdr && !map->includes_phdrs)
5641 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
5642 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
5643 segment's vma. */
5644 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
5645
5646 free (sections);
5647 continue;
5648 }
5649 else
5650 {
5651 if (matching_lma != 0)
5652 {
5653 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
5654 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
5655 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
5656 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
5657 }
5658 else
5659 {
5660 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
5661 Change the current segment's physical address to match
5662 the LMA of the first section. */
5663 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5664 }
5665
5666 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
5667 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
5668 if (map->includes_filehdr)
5669 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
5670
5671 if (map->includes_phdrs)
5672 {
5673 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5674
5675 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
5676 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
5677 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
5678 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
5679 offset when we know the correct value. */
5680 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
5681 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
5682 }
5683 }
5684
5685 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
5686 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
5687 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
5688 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
5689 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
5690 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
5691 the loop. */
5692 isec = 0;
5693 do
5694 {
5695 map->count = 0;
5696 suggested_lma = 0;
5697
5698 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
5699 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
5700 {
5701 section = sections[j];
5702
5703 if (section == NULL)
5704 continue;
5705
5706 output_section = section->output_section;
5707
5708 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
5709
5710 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
5711 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
5712 {
5713 if (map->count == 0)
5714 {
5715 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
5716 the beginning of the segment, then something is
5717 wrong. */
5718 if (output_section->lma !=
5719 (map->p_paddr
5720 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
5721 + (map->includes_phdrs
5722 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
5723 : 0)))
5724 abort ();
5725 }
5726 else
5727 {
5728 asection * prev_sec;
5729
5730 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
5731
5732 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
5733 and the start of this section is more than
5734 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
5735 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
5736 maxpagesize)
5737 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
5738 || ((prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size)
5739 > output_section->lma))
5740 {
5741 if (suggested_lma == 0)
5742 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5743
5744 continue;
5745 }
5746 }
5747
5748 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
5749 ++isec;
5750 sections[j] = NULL;
5751 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
5752 }
5753 else if (suggested_lma == 0)
5754 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
5755 }
5756
5757 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
5758
5759 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
5760 *pointer_to_map = map;
5761 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5762
5763 if (isec < section_count)
5764 {
5765 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
5766 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
5767 and carry on looping. */
5768 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5769 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5770 map = bfd_alloc (obfd, amt);
5771 if (map == NULL)
5772 {
5773 free (sections);
5774 return FALSE;
5775 }
5776
5777 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
5778 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
5779 not yet been assigned. */
5780 map->next = NULL;
5781 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5782 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5783 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5784 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
5785 map->p_paddr_valid = 1;
5786 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
5787 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5788 }
5789 }
5790 while (isec < section_count);
5791
5792 free (sections);
5793 }
5794
5795 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
5796 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
5797 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
5798 reset the p_paddr_valid fields. */
5799 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
5800 if (map->p_paddr != 0)
5801 break;
5802 if (map == NULL)
5803 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
5804 map->p_paddr_valid = 0;
5805
5806 elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
5807
5808 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
5809 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
5810 the offset if necessary. */
5811 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
5812 {
5813 unsigned int count;
5814
5815 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
5816 count++;
5817
5818 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
5819 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
5820 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
5821 }
5822
5823 #undef SEGMENT_END
5824 #undef SECTION_SIZE
5825 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
5826 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
5827 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
5828 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
5829 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
5830 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
5831 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
5832 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
5833 return TRUE;
5834 }
5835
5836 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
5837
5838 static bfd_boolean
5839 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5840 {
5841 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
5842 struct elf_segment_map *map;
5843 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
5844 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
5845 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5846 unsigned int i;
5847 unsigned int num_segments;
5848 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
5849
5850 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
5851
5852 map_first = NULL;
5853 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
5854
5855 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5856 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5857 i < num_segments;
5858 i++, segment++)
5859 {
5860 asection *section;
5861 unsigned int section_count;
5862 bfd_size_type amt;
5863 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5864 asection *first_section = NULL;
5865
5866 /* FIXME: Do we need to copy PT_NULL segment? */
5867 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
5868 continue;
5869
5870 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
5871 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
5872 section != NULL;
5873 section = section->next)
5874 {
5875 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
5876 if (ELF_IS_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_FILE (this_hdr, segment))
5877 {
5878 if (!first_section)
5879 first_section = section;
5880 section_count++;
5881 }
5882 }
5883
5884 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
5885 all of the sections we have selected. */
5886 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5887 if (section_count != 0)
5888 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
5889 map = bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
5890 if (map == NULL)
5891 return FALSE;
5892
5893 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
5894 input segment. */
5895 map->next = NULL;
5896 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
5897 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
5898 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
5899 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
5900 map->p_paddr_valid = 1;
5901 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
5902 map->p_align_valid = 1;
5903 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
5904
5905 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
5906 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
5907 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
5908 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
5909
5910 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
5911 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5912 {
5913 map->includes_phdrs =
5914 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5915 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
5916 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
5917 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
5918
5919 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
5920 phdr_included = TRUE;
5921 }
5922
5923 if (!map->includes_phdrs && !map->includes_filehdr)
5924 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
5925 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((first_section ? first_section->lma : 0)
5926 - segment->p_paddr);
5927
5928 if (section_count != 0)
5929 {
5930 unsigned int isec = 0;
5931
5932 for (section = first_section;
5933 section != NULL;
5934 section = section->next)
5935 {
5936 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
5937 if (ELF_IS_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_FILE (this_hdr, segment))
5938 {
5939 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
5940 if (isec == section_count)
5941 break;
5942 }
5943 }
5944 }
5945
5946 map->count = section_count;
5947 *pointer_to_map = map;
5948 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
5949 }
5950
5951 elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
5952 return TRUE;
5953 }
5954
5955 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
5956 information. */
5957
5958 static bfd_boolean
5959 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
5960 {
5961 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
5962 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
5963 return TRUE;
5964
5965 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
5966 return TRUE;
5967
5968 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
5969 {
5970 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
5971 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
5972 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
5973 asection *section, *osec;
5974 unsigned int i, num_segments;
5975 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5976
5977 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
5978 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
5979 section = section->next)
5980 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
5981
5982 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
5983 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
5984 i < num_segments;
5985 i++, segment++)
5986 {
5987 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
5988 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
5989 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
5990 map in this case. */
5991 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
5992 && segment->p_memsz == 0
5993 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
5994 goto rewrite;
5995
5996 for (section = ibfd->sections;
5997 section != NULL; section = section->next)
5998 {
5999 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
6000 from the input BFD. */
6001 osec = section->output_section;
6002 if (osec)
6003 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
6004
6005 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
6006 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
6007 if (ELF_IS_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_FILE (this_hdr, segment))
6008 {
6009 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
6010 removed. What else do we need to check? */
6011 if (osec == NULL
6012 || section->flags != osec->flags
6013 || section->lma != osec->lma
6014 || section->vma != osec->vma
6015 || section->size != osec->size
6016 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
6017 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
6018 goto rewrite;
6019 }
6020 }
6021 }
6022
6023 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
6024 input BFD. */
6025 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
6026 section = section->next)
6027 {
6028 if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
6029 goto rewrite;
6030 else
6031 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6032 }
6033
6034 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6035 }
6036
6037 rewrite:
6038 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
6039 }
6040
6041 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
6042
6043 bfd_boolean
6044 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6045 asection *isec,
6046 bfd *obfd,
6047 asection *osec,
6048 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6049
6050 {
6051 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6052 bfd_boolean need_group = link_info == NULL || link_info->relocatable;
6053
6054 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6055 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6056 return TRUE;
6057
6058 /* Don't copy the output ELF section type from input if the
6059 output BFD section flags have been set to something different.
6060 elf_fake_sections will set ELF section type based on BFD
6061 section flags. */
6062 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
6063 && (osec->flags == isec->flags || !osec->flags))
6064 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
6065
6066 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
6067 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
6068 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
6069
6070 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
6071 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
6072 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
6073 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
6074 if (need_group)
6075 {
6076 if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
6077 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6078 {
6079 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
6080 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
6081 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6082 elf_group_name (osec) = elf_group_name (isec);
6083 }
6084 }
6085
6086 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6087
6088 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
6089 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
6090 may be NULL at this point. */
6091 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
6092 {
6093 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6094 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
6095 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
6096 }
6097
6098 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
6099
6100 return TRUE;
6101 }
6102
6103 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
6104 field, and sometimes the info field. */
6105
6106 bfd_boolean
6107 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
6108 asection *isec,
6109 bfd *obfd,
6110 asection *osec)
6111 {
6112 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
6113
6114 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6115 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6116 return TRUE;
6117
6118 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
6119 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
6120
6121 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
6122
6123 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
6124 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
6125 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
6126 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
6127 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
6128
6129 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
6130 NULL);
6131 }
6132
6133 /* Copy private header information. */
6134
6135 bfd_boolean
6136 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6137 {
6138 asection *isec;
6139
6140 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6141 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6142 return TRUE;
6143
6144 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
6145 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
6146 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
6147 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
6148 already been worked out. */
6149 if (elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
6150 {
6151 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
6152 return FALSE;
6153 }
6154
6155 /* _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data copied over the SHF_GROUP flag
6156 but this might be wrong if we deleted the group section. */
6157 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
6158 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP
6159 && isec->output_section == NULL)
6160 {
6161 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
6162 asection *s = first;
6163 while (s != NULL)
6164 {
6165 if (s->output_section != NULL)
6166 {
6167 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
6168 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
6169 }
6170 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
6171 if (s == first)
6172 break;
6173 }
6174 }
6175
6176 return TRUE;
6177 }
6178
6179 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
6180 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
6181 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
6182 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
6183 swap_out_syms function. */
6184
6185 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
6186 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
6187 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
6188 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
6189 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
6190
6191 bfd_boolean
6192 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
6193 asymbol *isymarg,
6194 bfd *obfd,
6195 asymbol *osymarg)
6196 {
6197 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
6198
6199 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
6200 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6201 return TRUE;
6202
6203 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
6204 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
6205
6206 if (isym != NULL
6207 && osym != NULL
6208 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
6209 {
6210 unsigned int shndx;
6211
6212 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6213 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
6214 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
6215 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
6216 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
6217 else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->strtab_section)
6218 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
6219 else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->shstrtab_section)
6220 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
6221 else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_section)
6222 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
6223 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6224 }
6225
6226 return TRUE;
6227 }
6228
6229 /* Swap out the symbols. */
6230
6231 static bfd_boolean
6232 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
6233 struct bfd_strtab_hash **sttp,
6234 int relocatable_p)
6235 {
6236 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6237 int symcount;
6238 asymbol **syms;
6239 struct bfd_strtab_hash *stt;
6240 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6241 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
6242 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
6243 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
6244 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
6245 int idx;
6246 bfd_size_type amt;
6247 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
6248
6249 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd))
6250 return FALSE;
6251
6252 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
6253 stt = _bfd_elf_stringtab_init ();
6254 if (stt == NULL)
6255 return FALSE;
6256
6257 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6258 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
6259 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6260 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
6261 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6262 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
6263 symtab_hdr->sh_info = elf_num_locals (abfd) + 1;
6264 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
6265
6266 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
6267 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6268
6269 outbound_syms = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, bed->s->sizeof_sym);
6270 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
6271 {
6272 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6273 return FALSE;
6274 }
6275 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
6276
6277 outbound_shndx = NULL;
6278 symtab_shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
6279 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
6280 {
6281 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6282 outbound_shndx = bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
6283 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
6284 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
6285 {
6286 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6287 return FALSE;
6288 }
6289
6290 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
6291 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
6292 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
6293 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6294 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6295 }
6296
6297 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
6298 {
6299 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
6300 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6301 sym.st_name = 0;
6302 sym.st_value = 0;
6303 sym.st_size = 0;
6304 sym.st_info = 0;
6305 sym.st_other = 0;
6306 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
6307 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6308 outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6309 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6310 outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6311 }
6312
6313 name_local_sections
6314 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
6315 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
6316
6317 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
6318 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
6319 {
6320 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
6321 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
6322 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
6323 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
6324 int type;
6325
6326 if (!name_local_sections
6327 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6328 {
6329 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
6330 sym.st_name = 0;
6331 }
6332 else
6333 {
6334 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) _bfd_stringtab_add (stt,
6335 syms[idx]->name,
6336 TRUE, FALSE);
6337 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
6338 {
6339 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6340 return FALSE;
6341 }
6342 }
6343
6344 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
6345
6346 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
6347 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6348 {
6349 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
6350 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
6351 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
6352 sym.st_size = value;
6353 if (type_ptr == NULL
6354 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
6355 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
6356 else
6357 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
6358 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
6359 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
6360 }
6361 else
6362 {
6363 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
6364 int shndx;
6365
6366 if (sec->output_section)
6367 {
6368 value += sec->output_offset;
6369 sec = sec->output_section;
6370 }
6371
6372 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
6373 if (! relocatable_p)
6374 value += sec->vma;
6375 sym.st_value = value;
6376 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
6377
6378 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
6379 && type_ptr != NULL
6380 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
6381 {
6382 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
6383 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
6384 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
6385 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
6386 switch (shndx)
6387 {
6388 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
6389 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
6390 break;
6391 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
6392 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
6393 break;
6394 case MAP_STRTAB:
6395 shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_section;
6396 break;
6397 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
6398 shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_section;
6399 break;
6400 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
6401 shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_section;
6402 break;
6403 default:
6404 break;
6405 }
6406 }
6407 else
6408 {
6409 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
6410
6411 if (shndx == -1)
6412 {
6413 asection *sec2;
6414
6415 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
6416 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
6417 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
6418 demand of applications. For example, it
6419 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
6420 section of a symbol to be a section that is
6421 actually in the output file. */
6422 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
6423 if (sec2 == NULL)
6424 {
6425 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6426 Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
6427 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
6428 sec->name);
6429 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6430 _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
6431 return FALSE;
6432 }
6433
6434 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
6435 BFD_ASSERT (shndx != -1);
6436 }
6437 }
6438
6439 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
6440 }
6441
6442 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
6443 type = STT_TLS;
6444 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
6445 type = STT_FUNC;
6446 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
6447 type = STT_OBJECT;
6448 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
6449 type = STT_RELC;
6450 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
6451 type = STT_SRELC;
6452 else
6453 type = STT_NOTYPE;
6454
6455 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
6456 type = STT_TLS;
6457
6458 /* Processor-specific types. */
6459 if (type_ptr != NULL
6460 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6461 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
6462 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
6463
6464 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6465 {
6466 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6467 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
6468 else
6469 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
6470 }
6471 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
6472 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
6473 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
6474 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
6475 ? STB_WEAK
6476 : STB_GLOBAL),
6477 type);
6478 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
6479 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
6480 else
6481 {
6482 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
6483
6484 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
6485 bind = STB_LOCAL;
6486 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
6487 bind = STB_WEAK;
6488 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
6489 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
6490
6491 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
6492 }
6493
6494 if (type_ptr != NULL)
6495 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
6496 else
6497 sym.st_other = 0;
6498
6499 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
6500 outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
6501 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
6502 outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
6503 }
6504
6505 *sttp = stt;
6506 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_stringtab_size (stt);
6507 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
6508
6509 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
6510 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
6511 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6512 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
6513 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
6514 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
6515
6516 return TRUE;
6517 }
6518
6519 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
6520
6521 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
6522 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
6523 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
6524
6525 long
6526 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6527 {
6528 long symcount;
6529 long symtab_size;
6530 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6531
6532 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6533 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6534 if (symcount > 0)
6535 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6536
6537 return symtab_size;
6538 }
6539
6540 long
6541 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6542 {
6543 long symcount;
6544 long symtab_size;
6545 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
6546
6547 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6548 {
6549 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6550 return -1;
6551 }
6552
6553 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
6554 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
6555 if (symcount > 0)
6556 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
6557
6558 return symtab_size;
6559 }
6560
6561 long
6562 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6563 sec_ptr asect)
6564 {
6565 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
6566 }
6567
6568 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
6569
6570 long
6571 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
6572 sec_ptr section,
6573 arelent **relptr,
6574 asymbol **symbols)
6575 {
6576 arelent *tblptr;
6577 unsigned int i;
6578 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6579
6580 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
6581 return -1;
6582
6583 tblptr = section->relocation;
6584 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
6585 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
6586
6587 *relptr = NULL;
6588
6589 return section->reloc_count;
6590 }
6591
6592 long
6593 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
6594 {
6595 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6596 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
6597
6598 if (symcount >= 0)
6599 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
6600 return symcount;
6601 }
6602
6603 long
6604 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
6605 asymbol **allocation)
6606 {
6607 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6608 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
6609
6610 if (symcount >= 0)
6611 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
6612 return symcount;
6613 }
6614
6615 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
6616 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
6617 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
6618 dynamic reloc section. */
6619
6620 long
6621 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
6622 {
6623 long ret;
6624 asection *s;
6625
6626 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6627 {
6628 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6629 return -1;
6630 }
6631
6632 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
6633 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6634 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
6635 && elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
6636 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
6637 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
6638 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
6639 * sizeof (arelent *));
6640
6641 return ret;
6642 }
6643
6644 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
6645 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
6646 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
6647 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
6648 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
6649 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
6650 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
6651
6652 long
6653 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
6654 arelent **storage,
6655 asymbol **syms)
6656 {
6657 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
6658 asection *s;
6659 long ret;
6660
6661 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
6662 {
6663 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
6664 return -1;
6665 }
6666
6667 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
6668 ret = 0;
6669 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6670 {
6671 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
6672 && elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
6673 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
6674 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
6675 {
6676 arelent *p;
6677 long count, i;
6678
6679 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
6680 return -1;
6681 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
6682 p = s->relocation;
6683 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
6684 *storage++ = p++;
6685 ret += count;
6686 }
6687 }
6688
6689 *storage = NULL;
6690
6691 return ret;
6692 }
6693 \f
6694 /* Read in the version information. */
6695
6696 bfd_boolean
6697 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
6698 {
6699 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6700 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
6701
6702 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
6703 {
6704 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6705 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
6706 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
6707 unsigned int i;
6708 bfd_byte *contents_end;
6709
6710 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
6711
6712 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info,
6713 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
6714 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
6715 goto error_return;
6716
6717 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = hdr->sh_info;
6718
6719 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
6720 if (contents == NULL)
6721 {
6722 error_return_verref:
6723 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
6724 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
6725 goto error_return;
6726 }
6727 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6728 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
6729 goto error_return_verref;
6730
6731 if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
6732 goto error_return_verref;
6733
6734 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
6735 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
6736 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
6737 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
6738 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
6739 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
6740 {
6741 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
6742 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
6743 unsigned int j;
6744
6745 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
6746
6747 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
6748
6749 iverneed->vn_filename =
6750 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
6751 iverneed->vn_file);
6752 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
6753 goto error_return_verref;
6754
6755 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
6756 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
6757 else
6758 {
6759 iverneed->vn_auxptr = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
6760 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
6761 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
6762 goto error_return_verref;
6763 }
6764
6765 if (iverneed->vn_aux
6766 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
6767 goto error_return_verref;
6768
6769 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
6770 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
6771 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
6772 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
6773 {
6774 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
6775
6776 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
6777 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
6778 ivernaux->vna_name);
6779 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
6780 goto error_return_verref;
6781
6782 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
6783 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
6784 else
6785 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
6786
6787 if (ivernaux->vna_next
6788 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
6789 goto error_return_verref;
6790
6791 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
6792 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
6793
6794 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
6795 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
6796 }
6797
6798 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
6799 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
6800 else
6801 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
6802
6803 if (iverneed->vn_next
6804 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
6805 goto error_return_verref;
6806
6807 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
6808 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
6809 }
6810
6811 free (contents);
6812 contents = NULL;
6813 }
6814
6815 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
6816 {
6817 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6818 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
6819 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
6820 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
6821 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
6822 unsigned int i;
6823 unsigned int maxidx;
6824 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
6825
6826 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
6827
6828 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
6829 if (contents == NULL)
6830 goto error_return;
6831 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6832 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
6833 goto error_return;
6834
6835 if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
6836 goto error_return;
6837
6838 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
6839 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
6840 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
6841 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
6842 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
6843 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
6844
6845 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
6846 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
6847 the maximum. */
6848 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
6849 maxidx = 0;
6850 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
6851 {
6852 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
6853
6854 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
6855 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
6856
6857 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
6858 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
6859 goto error_return;
6860
6861 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
6862 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
6863 }
6864
6865 if (default_imported_symver)
6866 {
6867 if (freeidx > maxidx)
6868 maxidx = ++freeidx;
6869 else
6870 freeidx = ++maxidx;
6871 }
6872 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx,
6873 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
6874 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
6875 goto error_return;
6876
6877 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
6878
6879 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
6880 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
6881 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
6882 {
6883 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
6884 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
6885 unsigned int j;
6886
6887 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
6888
6889 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
6890 {
6891 error_return_verdef:
6892 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
6893 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
6894 goto error_return;
6895 }
6896
6897 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
6898 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
6899
6900 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
6901
6902 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
6903 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
6904 else
6905 {
6906 iverdef->vd_auxptr = bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
6907 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
6908 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
6909 goto error_return_verdef;
6910 }
6911
6912 if (iverdef->vd_aux
6913 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
6914 goto error_return_verdef;
6915
6916 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
6917 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
6918 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
6919 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
6920 {
6921 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
6922
6923 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
6924 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
6925 iverdaux->vda_name);
6926 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
6927 goto error_return_verdef;
6928
6929 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
6930 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
6931 else
6932 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
6933
6934 if (iverdaux->vda_next
6935 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
6936 goto error_return_verdef;
6937
6938 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
6939 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
6940 }
6941
6942 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
6943 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
6944
6945 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
6946 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
6947 else
6948 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
6949
6950 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
6951 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
6952 }
6953
6954 free (contents);
6955 contents = NULL;
6956 }
6957 else if (default_imported_symver)
6958 {
6959 if (freeidx < 3)
6960 freeidx = 3;
6961 else
6962 freeidx++;
6963
6964 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx,
6965 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
6966 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
6967 goto error_return;
6968
6969 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
6970 }
6971
6972 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
6973 if (default_imported_symver)
6974 {
6975 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
6976 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
6977
6978 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];;
6979
6980 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
6981 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
6982 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
6983 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
6984
6985 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
6986
6987 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
6988 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
6989 goto error_return_verdef;
6990 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
6991 iverdef->vd_auxptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
6992 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
6993 goto error_return_verdef;
6994
6995 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
6996 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
6997 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
6998 }
6999
7000 return TRUE;
7001
7002 error_return:
7003 if (contents != NULL)
7004 free (contents);
7005 return FALSE;
7006 }
7007 \f
7008 asymbol *
7009 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
7010 {
7011 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
7012 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (elf_symbol_type);
7013
7014 newsym = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7015 if (!newsym)
7016 return NULL;
7017 else
7018 {
7019 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
7020 return &newsym->symbol;
7021 }
7022 }
7023
7024 void
7025 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7026 asymbol *symbol,
7027 symbol_info *ret)
7028 {
7029 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
7030 }
7031
7032 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
7033 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
7034 override it. */
7035
7036 bfd_boolean
7037 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7038 const char *name)
7039 {
7040 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
7041 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
7042 return TRUE;
7043
7044 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
7045 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
7046 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
7047 return TRUE;
7048
7049 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
7050 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
7051 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
7052 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
7053 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
7054 we treat such symbols as local. */
7055 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
7056 return TRUE;
7057
7058 return FALSE;
7059 }
7060
7061 alent *
7062 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7063 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7064 {
7065 abort ();
7066 return NULL;
7067 }
7068
7069 bfd_boolean
7070 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
7071 enum bfd_architecture arch,
7072 unsigned long machine)
7073 {
7074 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
7075 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
7076 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
7077 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
7078 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
7079 return FALSE;
7080
7081 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
7082 }
7083
7084 /* Find the function to a particular section and offset,
7085 for error reporting. */
7086
7087 static bfd_boolean
7088 elf_find_function (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7089 asection *section,
7090 asymbol **symbols,
7091 bfd_vma offset,
7092 const char **filename_ptr,
7093 const char **functionname_ptr)
7094 {
7095 const char *filename;
7096 asymbol *func, *file;
7097 bfd_vma low_func;
7098 asymbol **p;
7099 /* ??? Given multiple file symbols, it is impossible to reliably
7100 choose the right file name for global symbols. File symbols are
7101 local symbols, and thus all file symbols must sort before any
7102 global symbols. The ELF spec may be interpreted to say that a
7103 file symbol must sort before other local symbols, but currently
7104 ld -r doesn't do this. So, for ld -r output, it is possible to
7105 make a better choice of file name for local symbols by ignoring
7106 file symbols appearing after a given local symbol. */
7107 enum { nothing_seen, symbol_seen, file_after_symbol_seen } state;
7108
7109 filename = NULL;
7110 func = NULL;
7111 file = NULL;
7112 low_func = 0;
7113 state = nothing_seen;
7114
7115 for (p = symbols; *p != NULL; p++)
7116 {
7117 elf_symbol_type *q;
7118
7119 q = (elf_symbol_type *) *p;
7120
7121 switch (ELF_ST_TYPE (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info))
7122 {
7123 default:
7124 break;
7125 case STT_FILE:
7126 file = &q->symbol;
7127 if (state == symbol_seen)
7128 state = file_after_symbol_seen;
7129 continue;
7130 case STT_NOTYPE:
7131 case STT_FUNC:
7132 if (bfd_get_section (&q->symbol) == section
7133 && q->symbol.value >= low_func
7134 && q->symbol.value <= offset)
7135 {
7136 func = (asymbol *) q;
7137 low_func = q->symbol.value;
7138 filename = NULL;
7139 if (file != NULL
7140 && (ELF_ST_BIND (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STB_LOCAL
7141 || state != file_after_symbol_seen))
7142 filename = bfd_asymbol_name (file);
7143 }
7144 break;
7145 }
7146 if (state == nothing_seen)
7147 state = symbol_seen;
7148 }
7149
7150 if (func == NULL)
7151 return FALSE;
7152
7153 if (filename_ptr)
7154 *filename_ptr = filename;
7155 if (functionname_ptr)
7156 *functionname_ptr = bfd_asymbol_name (func);
7157
7158 return TRUE;
7159 }
7160
7161 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
7162 for error reporting. */
7163
7164 bfd_boolean
7165 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
7166 asection *section,
7167 asymbol **symbols,
7168 bfd_vma offset,
7169 const char **filename_ptr,
7170 const char **functionname_ptr,
7171 unsigned int *line_ptr)
7172 {
7173 bfd_boolean found;
7174
7175 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7176 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7177 line_ptr))
7178 {
7179 if (!*functionname_ptr)
7180 elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7181 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7182 functionname_ptr);
7183
7184 return TRUE;
7185 }
7186
7187 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7188 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
7189 line_ptr, 0,
7190 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
7191 {
7192 if (!*functionname_ptr)
7193 elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7194 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
7195 functionname_ptr);
7196
7197 return TRUE;
7198 }
7199
7200 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
7201 &found, filename_ptr,
7202 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7203 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
7204 return FALSE;
7205 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
7206 return TRUE;
7207
7208 if (symbols == NULL)
7209 return FALSE;
7210
7211 if (! elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
7212 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
7213 return FALSE;
7214
7215 *line_ptr = 0;
7216 return TRUE;
7217 }
7218
7219 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
7220
7221 bfd_boolean
7222 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
7223 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
7224 {
7225 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_line (abfd, symbols, symbol,
7226 filename_ptr, line_ptr, 0,
7227 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7228 }
7229
7230 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
7231 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
7232 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
7233 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
7234 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
7235
7236 bfd_boolean
7237 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
7238 const char **filename_ptr,
7239 const char **functionname_ptr,
7240 unsigned int *line_ptr)
7241 {
7242 bfd_boolean found;
7243 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
7244 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
7245 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
7246 return found;
7247 }
7248
7249 int
7250 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7251 {
7252 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7253 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
7254
7255 if (!info->relocatable)
7256 {
7257 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
7258
7259 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
7260 {
7261 struct elf_segment_map *m;
7262
7263 phdr_size = 0;
7264 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
7265 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
7266
7267 if (phdr_size == 0)
7268 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
7269 }
7270
7271 elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = phdr_size;
7272 ret += phdr_size;
7273 }
7274
7275 return ret;
7276 }
7277
7278 bfd_boolean
7279 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
7280 sec_ptr section,
7281 const void *location,
7282 file_ptr offset,
7283 bfd_size_type count)
7284 {
7285 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
7286 bfd_signed_vma pos;
7287
7288 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
7289 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
7290 return FALSE;
7291
7292 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
7293 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
7294 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
7295 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
7296 return FALSE;
7297
7298 return TRUE;
7299 }
7300
7301 void
7302 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7303 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7304 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7305 {
7306 abort ();
7307 }
7308
7309 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
7310
7311 bfd_boolean
7312 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
7313 {
7314 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
7315
7316 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
7317 {
7318 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
7319 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7320
7321 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
7322 equivalent ELF reloc. */
7323
7324 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
7325 {
7326 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7327 {
7328 case 8:
7329 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
7330 break;
7331 case 12:
7332 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
7333 break;
7334 case 16:
7335 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
7336 break;
7337 case 24:
7338 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
7339 break;
7340 case 32:
7341 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
7342 break;
7343 case 64:
7344 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
7345 break;
7346 default:
7347 goto fail;
7348 }
7349
7350 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7351
7352 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
7353 {
7354 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
7355 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
7356 else
7357 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
7358 }
7359 }
7360 else
7361 {
7362 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
7363 {
7364 case 8:
7365 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
7366 break;
7367 case 14:
7368 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
7369 break;
7370 case 16:
7371 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
7372 break;
7373 case 26:
7374 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
7375 break;
7376 case 32:
7377 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
7378 break;
7379 case 64:
7380 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
7381 break;
7382 default:
7383 goto fail;
7384 }
7385
7386 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
7387 }
7388
7389 if (howto)
7390 areloc->howto = howto;
7391 else
7392 goto fail;
7393 }
7394
7395 return TRUE;
7396
7397 fail:
7398 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7399 (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
7400 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
7401 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7402 return FALSE;
7403 }
7404
7405 bfd_boolean
7406 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
7407 {
7408 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
7409 {
7410 if (elf_tdata (abfd) != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
7411 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
7412 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd);
7413 }
7414
7415 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
7416 }
7417
7418 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
7419 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
7420 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
7421 this reloc. */
7422
7423 bfd_reloc_status_type
7424 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
7425 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7426 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7427 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7428 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7429 {
7430 return bfd_reloc_ok;
7431 }
7432 \f
7433 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
7434 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
7435 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
7436 out details about the corefile. */
7437
7438 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
7439 # include <sys/procfs.h>
7440 #endif
7441
7442 /* FIXME: this is kinda wrong, but it's what gdb wants. */
7443
7444 static int
7445 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
7446 {
7447 return ((elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid << 16)
7448 + (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid));
7449 }
7450
7451 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
7452 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
7453 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
7454 overwrite it. */
7455
7456 static bfd_boolean
7457 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
7458 {
7459 asection *sect2;
7460
7461 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
7462 return TRUE;
7463
7464 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
7465 if (sect2 == NULL)
7466 return FALSE;
7467
7468 sect2->size = sect->size;
7469 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
7470 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
7471 return TRUE;
7472 }
7473
7474 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
7475 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
7476 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
7477 such a section already exists.
7478 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
7479 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
7480 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
7481 bfd_boolean
7482 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7483 char *name,
7484 size_t size,
7485 ufile_ptr filepos)
7486 {
7487 char buf[100];
7488 char *threaded_name;
7489 size_t len;
7490 asection *sect;
7491
7492 /* Build the section name. */
7493
7494 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
7495 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7496 threaded_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7497 if (threaded_name == NULL)
7498 return FALSE;
7499 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
7500
7501 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
7502 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7503 if (sect == NULL)
7504 return FALSE;
7505 sect->size = size;
7506 sect->filepos = filepos;
7507 sect->alignment_power = 2;
7508
7509 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
7510 }
7511
7512 /* prstatus_t exists on:
7513 solaris 2.5+
7514 linux 2.[01] + glibc
7515 unixware 4.2
7516 */
7517
7518 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
7519
7520 static bfd_boolean
7521 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7522 {
7523 size_t size;
7524 int offset;
7525
7526 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
7527 {
7528 prstatus_t prstat;
7529
7530 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
7531 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
7532 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
7533
7534 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
7535 has already been set by another thread. */
7536 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
7537 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
7538 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
7539
7540 /* pr_who exists on:
7541 solaris 2.5+
7542 unixware 4.2
7543 pr_who doesn't exist on:
7544 linux 2.[01]
7545 */
7546 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
7547 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
7548 #endif
7549 }
7550 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
7551 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
7552 {
7553 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
7554 prstatus32_t prstat;
7555
7556 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
7557 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
7558 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
7559
7560 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
7561 has already been set by another thread. */
7562 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
7563 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
7564 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
7565
7566 /* pr_who exists on:
7567 solaris 2.5+
7568 unixware 4.2
7569 pr_who doesn't exist on:
7570 linux 2.[01]
7571 */
7572 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
7573 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
7574 #endif
7575 }
7576 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
7577 else
7578 {
7579 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
7580 note size (ie. data object type). */
7581 return TRUE;
7582 }
7583
7584 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
7585 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
7586 size, note->descpos + offset);
7587 }
7588 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
7589
7590 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
7591 static bfd_boolean
7592 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
7593 char *name,
7594 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7595 {
7596 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
7597 note->descsz, note->descpos);
7598 }
7599
7600 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
7601 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
7602 data structure apart. */
7603
7604 static bfd_boolean
7605 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7606 {
7607 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
7608 }
7609
7610 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
7611 type of 5 (NT_PRXFPREG). Just include the whole note's contents
7612 literally. */
7613
7614 static bfd_boolean
7615 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7616 {
7617 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
7618 }
7619
7620 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
7621 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
7622 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
7623 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
7624 #endif
7625 #endif
7626
7627 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
7628 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
7629 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
7630 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
7631 #endif
7632 #endif
7633
7634 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
7635 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
7636 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
7637
7638 char *
7639 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
7640 {
7641 char *dups;
7642 char *end = memchr (start, '\0', max);
7643 size_t len;
7644
7645 if (end == NULL)
7646 len = max;
7647 else
7648 len = end - start;
7649
7650 dups = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
7651 if (dups == NULL)
7652 return NULL;
7653
7654 memcpy (dups, start, len);
7655 dups[len] = '\0';
7656
7657 return dups;
7658 }
7659
7660 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
7661 static bfd_boolean
7662 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7663 {
7664 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
7665 {
7666 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
7667
7668 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
7669
7670 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
7671 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
7672 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
7673
7674 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
7675 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
7676 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
7677 }
7678 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
7679 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
7680 {
7681 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
7682 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
7683
7684 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
7685
7686 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
7687 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
7688 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
7689
7690 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
7691 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
7692 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
7693 }
7694 #endif
7695
7696 else
7697 {
7698 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
7699 note size (ie. data object type). */
7700 return TRUE;
7701 }
7702
7703 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
7704 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
7705 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
7706
7707 {
7708 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
7709 int n = strlen (command);
7710
7711 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
7712 command[n - 1] = '\0';
7713 }
7714
7715 return TRUE;
7716 }
7717 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
7718
7719 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
7720 static bfd_boolean
7721 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7722 {
7723 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
7724 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
7725 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
7726 #endif
7727 )
7728 {
7729 pstatus_t pstat;
7730
7731 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
7732
7733 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
7734 }
7735 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
7736 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
7737 {
7738 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
7739 pstatus32_t pstat;
7740
7741 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
7742
7743 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
7744 }
7745 #endif
7746 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
7747 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
7748 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
7749
7750 return TRUE;
7751 }
7752 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
7753
7754 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
7755 static bfd_boolean
7756 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7757 {
7758 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
7759 char buf[100];
7760 char *name;
7761 size_t len;
7762 asection *sect;
7763
7764 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
7765 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
7766 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
7767 #endif
7768 )
7769 return TRUE;
7770
7771 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
7772
7773 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
7774 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
7775
7776 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
7777
7778 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
7779 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7780 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7781 if (name == NULL)
7782 return FALSE;
7783 memcpy (name, buf, len);
7784
7785 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7786 if (sect == NULL)
7787 return FALSE;
7788
7789 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
7790 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
7791 sect->filepos = note->descpos
7792 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
7793 #endif
7794
7795 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
7796 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
7797 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
7798 #endif
7799
7800 sect->alignment_power = 2;
7801
7802 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
7803 return FALSE;
7804
7805 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
7806
7807 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
7808 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7809 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7810 if (name == NULL)
7811 return FALSE;
7812 memcpy (name, buf, len);
7813
7814 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7815 if (sect == NULL)
7816 return FALSE;
7817
7818 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
7819 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
7820 sect->filepos = note->descpos
7821 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
7822 #endif
7823
7824 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
7825 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
7826 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
7827 #endif
7828
7829 sect->alignment_power = 2;
7830
7831 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
7832 }
7833 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
7834
7835 #if defined (HAVE_WIN32_PSTATUS_T)
7836 static bfd_boolean
7837 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7838 {
7839 char buf[30];
7840 char *name;
7841 size_t len;
7842 asection *sect;
7843 win32_pstatus_t pstatus;
7844
7845 if (note->descsz < sizeof (pstatus))
7846 return TRUE;
7847
7848 memcpy (&pstatus, note->descdata, sizeof (pstatus));
7849
7850 switch (pstatus.data_type)
7851 {
7852 case NOTE_INFO_PROCESS:
7853 /* FIXME: need to add ->core_command. */
7854 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = pstatus.data.process_info.signal;
7855 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstatus.data.process_info.pid;
7856 break;
7857
7858 case NOTE_INFO_THREAD:
7859 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
7860 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) pstatus.data.thread_info.tid);
7861
7862 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7863 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7864 if (name == NULL)
7865 return FALSE;
7866
7867 memcpy (name, buf, len);
7868
7869 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7870 if (sect == NULL)
7871 return FALSE;
7872
7873 sect->size = sizeof (pstatus.data.thread_info.thread_context);
7874 sect->filepos = (note->descpos
7875 + offsetof (struct win32_pstatus,
7876 data.thread_info.thread_context));
7877 sect->alignment_power = 2;
7878
7879 if (pstatus.data.thread_info.is_active_thread)
7880 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
7881 return FALSE;
7882 break;
7883
7884 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE:
7885 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
7886 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx",
7887 (long) pstatus.data.module_info.base_address);
7888
7889 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
7890 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
7891 if (name == NULL)
7892 return FALSE;
7893
7894 memcpy (name, buf, len);
7895
7896 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7897
7898 if (sect == NULL)
7899 return FALSE;
7900
7901 sect->size = note->descsz;
7902 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
7903 sect->alignment_power = 2;
7904 break;
7905
7906 default:
7907 return TRUE;
7908 }
7909
7910 return TRUE;
7911 }
7912 #endif /* HAVE_WIN32_PSTATUS_T */
7913
7914 static bfd_boolean
7915 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
7916 {
7917 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7918
7919 switch (note->type)
7920 {
7921 default:
7922 return TRUE;
7923
7924 case NT_PRSTATUS:
7925 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
7926 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
7927 return TRUE;
7928 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
7929 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
7930 #else
7931 return TRUE;
7932 #endif
7933
7934 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
7935 case NT_PSTATUS:
7936 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
7937 #endif
7938
7939 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
7940 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
7941 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
7942 #endif
7943
7944 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
7945 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
7946
7947 #if defined (HAVE_WIN32_PSTATUS_T)
7948 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
7949 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
7950 #endif
7951
7952 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
7953 if (note->namesz == 6
7954 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
7955 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
7956 else
7957 return TRUE;
7958
7959 case NT_PRPSINFO:
7960 case NT_PSINFO:
7961 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
7962 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
7963 return TRUE;
7964 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
7965 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
7966 #else
7967 return TRUE;
7968 #endif
7969
7970 case NT_AUXV:
7971 {
7972 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
7973 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7974
7975 if (sect == NULL)
7976 return FALSE;
7977 sect->size = note->descsz;
7978 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
7979 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
7980
7981 return TRUE;
7982 }
7983 }
7984 }
7985
7986 static bfd_boolean
7987 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
7988 {
7989 char *cp;
7990
7991 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
7992 if (cp != NULL)
7993 {
7994 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
7995 return TRUE;
7996 }
7997 return FALSE;
7998 }
7999
8000 static bfd_boolean
8001 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8002 {
8003 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
8004 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
8005 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
8006
8007 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
8008 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
8009 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
8010
8011 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
8012 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
8013 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
8014
8015 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
8016 note);
8017 }
8018
8019 static bfd_boolean
8020 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8021 {
8022 int lwp;
8023
8024 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
8025 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwp;
8026
8027 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
8028 {
8029 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
8030 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
8031 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
8032 creates a core file. */
8033
8034 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
8035 }
8036
8037 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
8038 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
8039 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
8040 understand it. */
8041
8042 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
8043 return TRUE;
8044
8045
8046 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
8047 {
8048 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
8049 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
8050
8051 case bfd_arch_alpha:
8052 case bfd_arch_sparc:
8053 switch (note->type)
8054 {
8055 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
8056 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8057
8058 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
8059 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8060
8061 default:
8062 return TRUE;
8063 }
8064
8065 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
8066 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
8067
8068 default:
8069 switch (note->type)
8070 {
8071 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
8072 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
8073
8074 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
8075 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
8076
8077 default:
8078 return TRUE;
8079 }
8080 }
8081 /* NOTREACHED */
8082 }
8083
8084 static bfd_boolean
8085 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
8086 {
8087 void *ddata = note->descdata;
8088 char buf[100];
8089 char *name;
8090 asection *sect;
8091 short sig;
8092 unsigned flags;
8093
8094 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
8095 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
8096
8097 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
8098 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
8099
8100 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
8101 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
8102
8103 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
8104 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
8105 {
8106 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = sig;
8107 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
8108 }
8109
8110 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
8111 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
8112 thread just in case. */
8113 if (flags & 0x00000080)
8114 elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
8115
8116 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
8117 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
8118
8119 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8120 if (name == NULL)
8121 return FALSE;
8122 strcpy (name, buf);
8123
8124 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8125 if (sect == NULL)
8126 return FALSE;
8127
8128 sect->size = note->descsz;
8129 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8130 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8131
8132 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
8133 }
8134
8135 static bfd_boolean
8136 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
8137 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
8138 long tid,
8139 char *base)
8140 {
8141 char buf[100];
8142 char *name;
8143 asection *sect;
8144
8145 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
8146 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
8147
8148 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
8149 if (name == NULL)
8150 return FALSE;
8151 strcpy (name, buf);
8152
8153 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8154 if (sect == NULL)
8155 return FALSE;
8156
8157 sect->size = note->descsz;
8158 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
8159 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8160
8161 /* This is the current thread. */
8162 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid == tid)
8163 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
8164
8165 return TRUE;
8166 }
8167
8168 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
8169 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
8170 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
8171 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
8172
8173 static bfd_boolean
8174 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8175 {
8176 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
8177 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
8178 function. */
8179 static long tid = 1;
8180
8181 switch (note->type)
8182 {
8183 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
8184 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
8185 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
8186 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
8187 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
8188 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
8189 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
8190 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
8191 default:
8192 return TRUE;
8193 }
8194 }
8195
8196 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
8197
8198 Inputs:
8199 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
8200 name of note
8201 type of note
8202 data for note
8203 size of data for note
8204
8205 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
8206 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
8207 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
8208 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
8209
8210 Return:
8211 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
8212
8213 char *
8214 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
8215 char *buf,
8216 int *bufsiz,
8217 const char *name,
8218 int type,
8219 const void *input,
8220 int size)
8221 {
8222 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
8223 size_t namesz;
8224 size_t newspace;
8225 char *dest;
8226
8227 namesz = 0;
8228 if (name != NULL)
8229 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
8230
8231 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
8232
8233 buf = realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
8234 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
8235 *bufsiz += newspace;
8236 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
8237 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
8238 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
8239 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
8240 dest = xnp->name;
8241 if (name != NULL)
8242 {
8243 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
8244 dest += namesz;
8245 while (namesz & 3)
8246 {
8247 *dest++ = '\0';
8248 ++namesz;
8249 }
8250 }
8251 memcpy (dest, input, size);
8252 dest += size;
8253 while (size & 3)
8254 {
8255 *dest++ = '\0';
8256 ++size;
8257 }
8258 return buf;
8259 }
8260
8261 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8262 char *
8263 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
8264 char *buf,
8265 int *bufsiz,
8266 const char *fname,
8267 const char *psargs)
8268 {
8269 const char *note_name = "CORE";
8270 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8271
8272 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
8273 {
8274 char *ret;
8275 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8276 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
8277 if (ret != NULL)
8278 return ret;
8279 }
8280
8281 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8282 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8283 {
8284 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
8285 psinfo32_t data;
8286 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
8287 #else
8288 prpsinfo32_t data;
8289 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
8290 #endif
8291
8292 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
8293 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
8294 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
8295 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8296 note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
8297 }
8298 else
8299 #endif
8300 {
8301 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
8302 psinfo_t data;
8303 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
8304 #else
8305 prpsinfo_t data;
8306 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
8307 #endif
8308
8309 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
8310 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
8311 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
8312 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8313 note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
8314 }
8315 }
8316 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
8317
8318 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8319 char *
8320 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
8321 char *buf,
8322 int *bufsiz,
8323 long pid,
8324 int cursig,
8325 const void *gregs)
8326 {
8327 const char *note_name = "CORE";
8328 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8329
8330 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
8331 {
8332 char *ret;
8333 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8334 NT_PRSTATUS,
8335 pid, cursig, gregs);
8336 if (ret != NULL)
8337 return ret;
8338 }
8339
8340 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
8341 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8342 {
8343 prstatus32_t prstat;
8344
8345 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
8346 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
8347 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8348 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
8349 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8350 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
8351 }
8352 else
8353 #endif
8354 {
8355 prstatus_t prstat;
8356
8357 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
8358 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
8359 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8360 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
8361 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8362 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
8363 }
8364 }
8365 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
8366
8367 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
8368 char *
8369 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
8370 char *buf,
8371 int *bufsiz,
8372 long pid,
8373 int cursig,
8374 const void *gregs)
8375 {
8376 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
8377 const char *note_name = "CORE";
8378
8379 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
8380 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
8381 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
8382 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
8383 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
8384 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
8385 #if !defined(gregs)
8386 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
8387 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
8388 #else
8389 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
8390 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
8391 #endif
8392 #endif
8393 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8394 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
8395 }
8396 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
8397
8398 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
8399 char *
8400 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
8401 char *buf,
8402 int *bufsiz,
8403 long pid,
8404 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8405 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8406 {
8407 const char *note_name = "CORE";
8408 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
8409 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8410
8411 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
8412 {
8413 pstatus32_t pstat;
8414
8415 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
8416 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
8417 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8418 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
8419 return buf;
8420 }
8421 else
8422 #endif
8423 {
8424 pstatus_t pstat;
8425
8426 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
8427 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
8428 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
8429 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
8430 return buf;
8431 }
8432 }
8433 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
8434
8435 char *
8436 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
8437 char *buf,
8438 int *bufsiz,
8439 const void *fpregs,
8440 int size)
8441 {
8442 const char *note_name = "CORE";
8443 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8444 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
8445 }
8446
8447 char *
8448 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
8449 char *buf,
8450 int *bufsiz,
8451 const void *xfpregs,
8452 int size)
8453 {
8454 char *note_name = "LINUX";
8455 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
8456 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
8457 }
8458
8459 static bfd_boolean
8460 elfcore_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
8461 {
8462 char *buf;
8463 char *p;
8464
8465 if (size <= 0)
8466 return TRUE;
8467
8468 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8469 return FALSE;
8470
8471 buf = bfd_malloc (size);
8472 if (buf == NULL)
8473 return FALSE;
8474
8475 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size)
8476 {
8477 error:
8478 free (buf);
8479 return FALSE;
8480 }
8481
8482 p = buf;
8483 while (p < buf + size)
8484 {
8485 /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
8486 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
8487 Elf_Internal_Note in;
8488
8489 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
8490
8491 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
8492 in.namedata = xnp->name;
8493
8494 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
8495 in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
8496 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
8497
8498 if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "NetBSD-CORE"))
8499 {
8500 if (! elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (abfd, &in))
8501 goto error;
8502 }
8503 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "QNX"))
8504 {
8505 if (! elfcore_grok_nto_note (abfd, &in))
8506 goto error;
8507 }
8508 else
8509 {
8510 if (! elfcore_grok_note (abfd, &in))
8511 goto error;
8512 }
8513
8514 p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
8515 }
8516
8517 free (buf);
8518 return TRUE;
8519 }
8520 \f
8521 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
8522
8523 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
8524 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
8525 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
8526
8527 long
8528 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8529 {
8530 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8531 {
8532 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
8533 return -1;
8534 }
8535
8536 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
8537 }
8538
8539 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
8540 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
8541 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
8542 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
8543
8544 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
8545 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
8546
8547 int
8548 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
8549 {
8550 int num_phdrs;
8551
8552 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8553 {
8554 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
8555 return -1;
8556 }
8557
8558 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
8559 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
8560 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
8561
8562 return num_phdrs;
8563 }
8564
8565 void
8566 _bfd_elf_sprintf_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char *buf, bfd_vma value)
8567 {
8568 #ifdef BFD64
8569 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form */
8570
8571 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
8572 if (i_ehdrp == NULL)
8573 sprintf_vma (buf, value);
8574 else
8575 {
8576 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
8577 {
8578 #if BFD_HOST_64BIT_LONG
8579 sprintf (buf, "%016lx", value);
8580 #else
8581 sprintf (buf, "%08lx%08lx", _bfd_int64_high (value),
8582 _bfd_int64_low (value));
8583 #endif
8584 }
8585 else
8586 sprintf (buf, "%08lx", (unsigned long) (value & 0xffffffff));
8587 }
8588 #else
8589 sprintf_vma (buf, value);
8590 #endif
8591 }
8592
8593 void
8594 _bfd_elf_fprintf_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *stream, bfd_vma value)
8595 {
8596 #ifdef BFD64
8597 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form */
8598
8599 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
8600 if (i_ehdrp == NULL)
8601 fprintf_vma ((FILE *) stream, value);
8602 else
8603 {
8604 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
8605 {
8606 #if BFD_HOST_64BIT_LONG
8607 fprintf ((FILE *) stream, "%016lx", value);
8608 #else
8609 fprintf ((FILE *) stream, "%08lx%08lx",
8610 _bfd_int64_high (value), _bfd_int64_low (value));
8611 #endif
8612 }
8613 else
8614 fprintf ((FILE *) stream, "%08lx",
8615 (unsigned long) (value & 0xffffffff));
8616 }
8617 #else
8618 fprintf_vma ((FILE *) stream, value);
8619 #endif
8620 }
8621
8622 enum elf_reloc_type_class
8623 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8624 {
8625 return reloc_class_normal;
8626 }
8627
8628 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
8629 relocation against a local symbol. */
8630
8631 bfd_vma
8632 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
8633 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
8634 asection **psec,
8635 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
8636 {
8637 asection *sec = *psec;
8638 bfd_vma relocation;
8639
8640 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
8641 + sec->output_offset
8642 + sym->st_value);
8643 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
8644 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
8645 && sec->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
8646 {
8647 rel->r_addend =
8648 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
8649 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
8650 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
8651 if (sec != *psec)
8652 {
8653 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
8654 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
8655 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
8656 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
8657 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
8658 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
8659 sec->kept_section = *psec;
8660 sec = *psec;
8661 }
8662 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
8663 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
8664 }
8665 return relocation;
8666 }
8667
8668 bfd_vma
8669 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
8670 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
8671 asection **psec,
8672 bfd_vma addend)
8673 {
8674 asection *sec = *psec;
8675
8676 if (sec->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
8677 return sym->st_value + addend;
8678
8679 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
8680 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
8681 sym->st_value + addend);
8682 }
8683
8684 bfd_vma
8685 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
8686 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8687 asection *sec,
8688 bfd_vma offset)
8689 {
8690 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
8691 {
8692 case ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
8693 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
8694 offset);
8695 case ELF_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
8696 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
8697 default:
8698 return offset;
8699 }
8700 }
8701 \f
8702 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
8703 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
8704 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
8705 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
8706 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
8707 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
8708
8709 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
8710 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
8711 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
8712 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
8713 the remote memory. */
8714
8715 bfd *
8716 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
8717 (bfd *templ,
8718 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
8719 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
8720 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, int))
8721 {
8722 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
8723 (templ, ehdr_vma, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
8724 }
8725 \f
8726 long
8727 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8728 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8729 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8730 long dynsymcount,
8731 asymbol **dynsyms,
8732 asymbol **ret)
8733 {
8734 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8735 asection *relplt;
8736 asymbol *s;
8737 const char *relplt_name;
8738 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8739 arelent *p;
8740 long count, i, n;
8741 size_t size;
8742 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8743 char *names;
8744 asection *plt;
8745
8746 *ret = NULL;
8747
8748 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
8749 return 0;
8750
8751 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
8752 return 0;
8753
8754 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
8755 return 0;
8756
8757 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
8758 if (relplt_name == NULL)
8759 relplt_name = bed->default_use_rela_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
8760 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
8761 if (relplt == NULL)
8762 return 0;
8763
8764 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
8765 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8766 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
8767 return 0;
8768
8769 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
8770 if (plt == NULL)
8771 return 0;
8772
8773 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8774 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
8775 return -1;
8776
8777 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
8778 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
8779 p = relplt->relocation;
8780 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, s++, p++)
8781 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
8782
8783 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
8784 if (s == NULL)
8785 return -1;
8786
8787 names = (char *) (s + count);
8788 p = relplt->relocation;
8789 n = 0;
8790 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, s++, p++)
8791 {
8792 size_t len;
8793 bfd_vma addr;
8794
8795 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
8796 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
8797 continue;
8798
8799 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
8800 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
8801 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
8802 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
8803 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
8804 s->section = plt;
8805 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
8806 s->name = names;
8807 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
8808 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
8809 names += len;
8810 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
8811 names += sizeof ("@plt");
8812 ++n;
8813 }
8814
8815 return n;
8816 }
8817
8818 struct elf_symbuf_symbol
8819 {
8820 unsigned long st_name; /* Symbol name, index in string tbl */
8821 unsigned char st_info; /* Type and binding attributes */
8822 unsigned char st_other; /* Visibilty, and target specific */
8823 };
8824
8825 struct elf_symbuf_head
8826 {
8827 struct elf_symbuf_symbol *ssym;
8828 bfd_size_type count;
8829 unsigned int st_shndx;
8830 };
8831
8832 struct elf_symbol
8833 {
8834 union
8835 {
8836 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
8837 struct elf_symbuf_symbol *ssym;
8838 } u;
8839 const char *name;
8840 };
8841
8842 /* Sort references to symbols by ascending section number. */
8843
8844 static int
8845 elf_sort_elf_symbol (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
8846 {
8847 const Elf_Internal_Sym *s1 = *(const Elf_Internal_Sym **) arg1;
8848 const Elf_Internal_Sym *s2 = *(const Elf_Internal_Sym **) arg2;
8849
8850 return s1->st_shndx - s2->st_shndx;
8851 }
8852
8853 static int
8854 elf_sym_name_compare (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
8855 {
8856 const struct elf_symbol *s1 = (const struct elf_symbol *) arg1;
8857 const struct elf_symbol *s2 = (const struct elf_symbol *) arg2;
8858 return strcmp (s1->name, s2->name);
8859 }
8860
8861 static struct elf_symbuf_head *
8862 elf_create_symbuf (bfd_size_type symcount, Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf)
8863 {
8864 Elf_Internal_Sym **ind, **indbufend, **indbuf
8865 = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (*indbuf));
8866 struct elf_symbuf_symbol *ssym;
8867 struct elf_symbuf_head *ssymbuf, *ssymhead;
8868 bfd_size_type i, shndx_count;
8869
8870 if (indbuf == NULL)
8871 return NULL;
8872
8873 for (ind = indbuf, i = 0; i < symcount; i++)
8874 if (isymbuf[i].st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF)
8875 *ind++ = &isymbuf[i];
8876 indbufend = ind;
8877
8878 qsort (indbuf, indbufend - indbuf, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym *),
8879 elf_sort_elf_symbol);
8880
8881 shndx_count = 0;
8882 if (indbufend > indbuf)
8883 for (ind = indbuf, shndx_count++; ind < indbufend - 1; ind++)
8884 if (ind[0]->st_shndx != ind[1]->st_shndx)
8885 shndx_count++;
8886
8887 ssymbuf = bfd_malloc ((shndx_count + 1) * sizeof (*ssymbuf)
8888 + (indbufend - indbuf) * sizeof (*ssymbuf));
8889 if (ssymbuf == NULL)
8890 {
8891 free (indbuf);
8892 return NULL;
8893 }
8894
8895 ssym = (struct elf_symbuf_symbol *) (ssymbuf + shndx_count);
8896 ssymbuf->ssym = NULL;
8897 ssymbuf->count = shndx_count;
8898 ssymbuf->st_shndx = 0;
8899 for (ssymhead = ssymbuf, ind = indbuf; ind < indbufend; ssym++, ind++)
8900 {
8901 if (ind == indbuf || ssymhead->st_shndx != (*ind)->st_shndx)
8902 {
8903 ssymhead++;
8904 ssymhead->ssym = ssym;
8905 ssymhead->count = 0;
8906 ssymhead->st_shndx = (*ind)->st_shndx;
8907 }
8908 ssym->st_name = (*ind)->st_name;
8909 ssym->st_info = (*ind)->st_info;
8910 ssym->st_other = (*ind)->st_other;
8911 ssymhead->count++;
8912 }
8913 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_size_type) (ssymhead - ssymbuf) == shndx_count);
8914
8915 free (indbuf);
8916 return ssymbuf;
8917 }
8918
8919 /* Check if 2 sections define the same set of local and global
8920 symbols. */
8921
8922 bfd_boolean
8923 bfd_elf_match_symbols_in_sections (asection *sec1, asection *sec2,
8924 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8925 {
8926 bfd *bfd1, *bfd2;
8927 const struct elf_backend_data *bed1, *bed2;
8928 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr1, *hdr2;
8929 bfd_size_type symcount1, symcount2;
8930 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf1, *isymbuf2;
8931 struct elf_symbuf_head *ssymbuf1, *ssymbuf2;
8932 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym, *isymend;
8933 struct elf_symbol *symtable1 = NULL, *symtable2 = NULL;
8934 bfd_size_type count1, count2, i;
8935 int shndx1, shndx2;
8936 bfd_boolean result;
8937
8938 bfd1 = sec1->owner;
8939 bfd2 = sec2->owner;
8940
8941 /* If both are .gnu.linkonce sections, they have to have the same
8942 section name. */
8943 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec1->name, ".gnu.linkonce")
8944 && CONST_STRNEQ (sec2->name, ".gnu.linkonce"))
8945 return strcmp (sec1->name + sizeof ".gnu.linkonce",
8946 sec2->name + sizeof ".gnu.linkonce") == 0;
8947
8948 /* Both sections have to be in ELF. */
8949 if (bfd_get_flavour (bfd1) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8950 || bfd_get_flavour (bfd2) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8951 return FALSE;
8952
8953 if (elf_section_type (sec1) != elf_section_type (sec2))
8954 return FALSE;
8955
8956 if ((elf_section_flags (sec1) & SHF_GROUP) != 0
8957 && (elf_section_flags (sec2) & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
8958 {
8959 /* If both are members of section groups, they have to have the
8960 same group name. */
8961 if (strcmp (elf_group_name (sec1), elf_group_name (sec2)) != 0)
8962 return FALSE;
8963 }
8964
8965 shndx1 = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd1, sec1);
8966 shndx2 = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd2, sec2);
8967 if (shndx1 == -1 || shndx2 == -1)
8968 return FALSE;
8969
8970 bed1 = get_elf_backend_data (bfd1);
8971 bed2 = get_elf_backend_data (bfd2);
8972 hdr1 = &elf_tdata (bfd1)->symtab_hdr;
8973 symcount1 = hdr1->sh_size / bed1->s->sizeof_sym;
8974 hdr2 = &elf_tdata (bfd2)->symtab_hdr;
8975 symcount2 = hdr2->sh_size / bed2->s->sizeof_sym;
8976
8977 if (symcount1 == 0 || symcount2 == 0)
8978 return FALSE;
8979
8980 result = FALSE;
8981 isymbuf1 = NULL;
8982 isymbuf2 = NULL;
8983 ssymbuf1 = elf_tdata (bfd1)->symbuf;
8984 ssymbuf2 = elf_tdata (bfd2)->symbuf;
8985
8986 if (ssymbuf1 == NULL)
8987 {
8988 isymbuf1 = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd1, hdr1, symcount1, 0,
8989 NULL, NULL, NULL);
8990 if (isymbuf1 == NULL)
8991 goto done;
8992
8993 if (!info->reduce_memory_overheads)
8994 elf_tdata (bfd1)->symbuf = ssymbuf1
8995 = elf_create_symbuf (symcount1, isymbuf1);
8996 }
8997
8998 if (ssymbuf1 == NULL || ssymbuf2 == NULL)
8999 {
9000 isymbuf2 = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd2, hdr2, symcount2, 0,
9001 NULL, NULL, NULL);
9002 if (isymbuf2 == NULL)
9003 goto done;
9004
9005 if (ssymbuf1 != NULL && !info->reduce_memory_overheads)
9006 elf_tdata (bfd2)->symbuf = ssymbuf2
9007 = elf_create_symbuf (symcount2, isymbuf2);
9008 }
9009
9010 if (ssymbuf1 != NULL && ssymbuf2 != NULL)
9011 {
9012 /* Optimized faster version. */
9013 bfd_size_type lo, hi, mid;
9014 struct elf_symbol *symp;
9015 struct elf_symbuf_symbol *ssym, *ssymend;
9016
9017 lo = 0;
9018 hi = ssymbuf1->count;
9019 ssymbuf1++;
9020 count1 = 0;
9021 while (lo < hi)
9022 {
9023 mid = (lo + hi) / 2;
9024 if ((unsigned int) shndx1 < ssymbuf1[mid].st_shndx)
9025 hi = mid;
9026 else if ((unsigned int) shndx1 > ssymbuf1[mid].st_shndx)
9027 lo = mid + 1;
9028 else
9029 {
9030 count1 = ssymbuf1[mid].count;
9031 ssymbuf1 += mid;
9032 break;
9033 }
9034 }
9035
9036 lo = 0;
9037 hi = ssymbuf2->count;
9038 ssymbuf2++;
9039 count2 = 0;
9040 while (lo < hi)
9041 {
9042 mid = (lo + hi) / 2;
9043 if ((unsigned int) shndx2 < ssymbuf2[mid].st_shndx)
9044 hi = mid;
9045 else if ((unsigned int) shndx2 > ssymbuf2[mid].st_shndx)
9046 lo = mid + 1;
9047 else
9048 {
9049 count2 = ssymbuf2[mid].count;
9050 ssymbuf2 += mid;
9051 break;
9052 }
9053 }
9054
9055 if (count1 == 0 || count2 == 0 || count1 != count2)
9056 goto done;
9057
9058 symtable1 = bfd_malloc (count1 * sizeof (struct elf_symbol));
9059 symtable2 = bfd_malloc (count2 * sizeof (struct elf_symbol));
9060 if (symtable1 == NULL || symtable2 == NULL)
9061 goto done;
9062
9063 symp = symtable1;
9064 for (ssym = ssymbuf1->ssym, ssymend = ssym + count1;
9065 ssym < ssymend; ssym++, symp++)
9066 {
9067 symp->u.ssym = ssym;
9068 symp->name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd1,
9069 hdr1->sh_link,
9070 ssym->st_name);
9071 }
9072
9073 symp = symtable2;
9074 for (ssym = ssymbuf2->ssym, ssymend = ssym + count2;
9075 ssym < ssymend; ssym++, symp++)
9076 {
9077 symp->u.ssym = ssym;
9078 symp->name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd2,
9079 hdr2->sh_link,
9080 ssym->st_name);
9081 }
9082
9083 /* Sort symbol by name. */
9084 qsort (symtable1, count1, sizeof (struct elf_symbol),
9085 elf_sym_name_compare);
9086 qsort (symtable2, count1, sizeof (struct elf_symbol),
9087 elf_sym_name_compare);
9088
9089 for (i = 0; i < count1; i++)
9090 /* Two symbols must have the same binding, type and name. */
9091 if (symtable1 [i].u.ssym->st_info != symtable2 [i].u.ssym->st_info
9092 || symtable1 [i].u.ssym->st_other != symtable2 [i].u.ssym->st_other
9093 || strcmp (symtable1 [i].name, symtable2 [i].name) != 0)
9094 goto done;
9095
9096 result = TRUE;
9097 goto done;
9098 }
9099
9100 symtable1 = bfd_malloc (symcount1 * sizeof (struct elf_symbol));
9101 symtable2 = bfd_malloc (symcount2 * sizeof (struct elf_symbol));
9102 if (symtable1 == NULL || symtable2 == NULL)
9103 goto done;
9104
9105 /* Count definitions in the section. */
9106 count1 = 0;
9107 for (isym = isymbuf1, isymend = isym + symcount1; isym < isymend; isym++)
9108 if (isym->st_shndx == (unsigned int) shndx1)
9109 symtable1[count1++].u.isym = isym;
9110
9111 count2 = 0;
9112 for (isym = isymbuf2, isymend = isym + symcount2; isym < isymend; isym++)
9113 if (isym->st_shndx == (unsigned int) shndx2)
9114 symtable2[count2++].u.isym = isym;
9115
9116 if (count1 == 0 || count2 == 0 || count1 != count2)
9117 goto done;
9118
9119 for (i = 0; i < count1; i++)
9120 symtable1[i].name
9121 = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd1, hdr1->sh_link,
9122 symtable1[i].u.isym->st_name);
9123
9124 for (i = 0; i < count2; i++)
9125 symtable2[i].name
9126 = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd2, hdr2->sh_link,
9127 symtable2[i].u.isym->st_name);
9128
9129 /* Sort symbol by name. */
9130 qsort (symtable1, count1, sizeof (struct elf_symbol),
9131 elf_sym_name_compare);
9132 qsort (symtable2, count1, sizeof (struct elf_symbol),
9133 elf_sym_name_compare);
9134
9135 for (i = 0; i < count1; i++)
9136 /* Two symbols must have the same binding, type and name. */
9137 if (symtable1 [i].u.isym->st_info != symtable2 [i].u.isym->st_info
9138 || symtable1 [i].u.isym->st_other != symtable2 [i].u.isym->st_other
9139 || strcmp (symtable1 [i].name, symtable2 [i].name) != 0)
9140 goto done;
9141
9142 result = TRUE;
9143
9144 done:
9145 if (symtable1)
9146 free (symtable1);
9147 if (symtable2)
9148 free (symtable2);
9149 if (isymbuf1)
9150 free (isymbuf1);
9151 if (isymbuf2)
9152 free (isymbuf2);
9153
9154 return result;
9155 }
9156
9157 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far. */
9158 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
9159 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
9160 SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
9161
9162 /* Return TRUE if 2 section types are compatible. */
9163
9164 bfd_boolean
9165 _bfd_elf_match_sections_by_type (bfd *abfd, const asection *asec,
9166 bfd *bbfd, const asection *bsec)
9167 {
9168 if (asec == NULL
9169 || bsec == NULL
9170 || abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
9171 || bbfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9172 return TRUE;
9173
9174 return elf_section_type (asec) == elf_section_type (bsec);
9175 }
9176
9177 void
9178 _bfd_elf_set_osabi (bfd * abfd,
9179 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9180 {
9181 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
9182
9183 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
9184
9185 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
9186 }
9187
9188
9189 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
9190 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
9191 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC. */
9192
9193 bfd_boolean
9194 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
9195 {
9196 return (type == STT_FUNC);
9197 }